LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/commands - trigger.c (source / functions) Coverage Total Hit
Test: PostgreSQL 19devel Lines: 94.1 % 2115 1991
Test Date: 2026-04-16 17:16:33 Functions: 98.6 % 73 72
Legend: Lines:     hit not hit

            Line data    Source code
       1              : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2              :  *
       3              :  * trigger.c
       4              :  *    PostgreSQL TRIGGERs support code.
       5              :  *
       6              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
       7              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
       8              :  *
       9              :  * IDENTIFICATION
      10              :  *    src/backend/commands/trigger.c
      11              :  *
      12              :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      13              :  */
      14              : #include "postgres.h"
      15              : 
      16              : #include "access/genam.h"
      17              : #include "access/htup_details.h"
      18              : #include "access/relation.h"
      19              : #include "access/sysattr.h"
      20              : #include "access/table.h"
      21              : #include "access/tableam.h"
      22              : #include "access/tupconvert.h"
      23              : #include "access/xact.h"
      24              : #include "catalog/catalog.h"
      25              : #include "catalog/dependency.h"
      26              : #include "catalog/indexing.h"
      27              : #include "catalog/objectaccess.h"
      28              : #include "catalog/partition.h"
      29              : #include "catalog/pg_constraint.h"
      30              : #include "catalog/pg_inherits.h"
      31              : #include "catalog/pg_proc.h"
      32              : #include "catalog/pg_trigger.h"
      33              : #include "catalog/pg_type.h"
      34              : #include "commands/trigger.h"
      35              : #include "executor/executor.h"
      36              : #include "executor/instrument.h"
      37              : #include "miscadmin.h"
      38              : #include "nodes/bitmapset.h"
      39              : #include "nodes/makefuncs.h"
      40              : #include "optimizer/optimizer.h"
      41              : #include "parser/parse_clause.h"
      42              : #include "parser/parse_collate.h"
      43              : #include "parser/parse_func.h"
      44              : #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
      45              : #include "partitioning/partdesc.h"
      46              : #include "pgstat.h"
      47              : #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
      48              : #include "rewrite/rewriteManip.h"
      49              : #include "storage/lmgr.h"
      50              : #include "utils/acl.h"
      51              : #include "utils/builtins.h"
      52              : #include "utils/fmgroids.h"
      53              : #include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
      54              : #include "utils/inval.h"
      55              : #include "utils/lsyscache.h"
      56              : #include "utils/memutils.h"
      57              : #include "utils/plancache.h"
      58              : #include "utils/rel.h"
      59              : #include "utils/snapmgr.h"
      60              : #include "utils/syscache.h"
      61              : #include "utils/tuplestore.h"
      62              : 
      63              : 
      64              : /* GUC variables */
      65              : int         SessionReplicationRole = SESSION_REPLICATION_ROLE_ORIGIN;
      66              : 
      67              : /* How many levels deep into trigger execution are we? */
      68              : static int  MyTriggerDepth = 0;
      69              : 
      70              : /* Local function prototypes */
      71              : static void renametrig_internal(Relation tgrel, Relation targetrel,
      72              :                                 HeapTuple trigtup, const char *newname,
      73              :                                 const char *expected_name);
      74              : static void renametrig_partition(Relation tgrel, Oid partitionId,
      75              :                                  Oid parentTriggerOid, const char *newname,
      76              :                                  const char *expected_name);
      77              : static void SetTriggerFlags(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Trigger *trigger);
      78              : static bool GetTupleForTrigger(EState *estate,
      79              :                                EPQState *epqstate,
      80              :                                ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      81              :                                ItemPointer tid,
      82              :                                LockTupleMode lockmode,
      83              :                                TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
      84              :                                bool do_epq_recheck,
      85              :                                TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
      86              :                                TM_Result *tmresultp,
      87              :                                TM_FailureData *tmfdp);
      88              : static bool TriggerEnabled(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      89              :                            Trigger *trigger, TriggerEvent event,
      90              :                            Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
      91              :                            TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot);
      92              : static HeapTuple ExecCallTriggerFunc(TriggerData *trigdata,
      93              :                                      int tgindx,
      94              :                                      FmgrInfo *finfo,
      95              :                                      TriggerInstrumentation *instr,
      96              :                                      MemoryContext per_tuple_context);
      97              : static void AfterTriggerSaveEvent(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      98              :                                   ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
      99              :                                   ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
     100              :                                   int event, bool row_trigger,
     101              :                                   TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot,
     102              :                                   List *recheckIndexes, Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
     103              :                                   TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
     104              :                                   bool is_crosspart_update);
     105              : static void AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState(void);
     106              : static bool before_stmt_triggers_fired(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType);
     107              : static HeapTuple check_modified_virtual_generated(TupleDesc tupdesc, HeapTuple tuple);
     108              : 
     109              : 
     110              : /*
     111              :  * Create a trigger.  Returns the address of the created trigger.
     112              :  *
     113              :  * queryString is the source text of the CREATE TRIGGER command.
     114              :  * This must be supplied if a whenClause is specified, else it can be NULL.
     115              :  *
     116              :  * relOid, if nonzero, is the relation on which the trigger should be
     117              :  * created.  If zero, the name provided in the statement will be looked up.
     118              :  *
     119              :  * refRelOid, if nonzero, is the relation to which the constraint trigger
     120              :  * refers.  If zero, the constraint relation name provided in the statement
     121              :  * will be looked up as needed.
     122              :  *
     123              :  * constraintOid, if nonzero, says that this trigger is being created
     124              :  * internally to implement that constraint.  A suitable pg_depend entry will
     125              :  * be made to link the trigger to that constraint.  constraintOid is zero when
     126              :  * executing a user-entered CREATE TRIGGER command.  (For CREATE CONSTRAINT
     127              :  * TRIGGER, we build a pg_constraint entry internally.)
     128              :  *
     129              :  * indexOid, if nonzero, is the OID of an index associated with the constraint.
     130              :  * We do nothing with this except store it into pg_trigger.tgconstrindid;
     131              :  * but when creating a trigger for a deferrable unique constraint on a
     132              :  * partitioned table, its children are looked up.  Note we don't cope with
     133              :  * invalid indexes in that case.
     134              :  *
     135              :  * funcoid, if nonzero, is the OID of the function to invoke.  When this is
     136              :  * given, stmt->funcname is ignored.
     137              :  *
     138              :  * parentTriggerOid, if nonzero, is a trigger that begets this one; so that
     139              :  * if that trigger is dropped, this one should be too.  There are two cases
     140              :  * when a nonzero value is passed for this: 1) when this function recurses to
     141              :  * create the trigger on partitions, 2) when creating child foreign key
     142              :  * triggers; see CreateFKCheckTrigger() and createForeignKeyActionTriggers().
     143              :  *
     144              :  * If whenClause is passed, it is an already-transformed expression for
     145              :  * WHEN.  In this case, we ignore any that may come in stmt->whenClause.
     146              :  *
     147              :  * If isInternal is true then this is an internally-generated trigger.
     148              :  * This argument sets the tgisinternal field of the pg_trigger entry, and
     149              :  * if true causes us to modify the given trigger name to ensure uniqueness.
     150              :  *
     151              :  * When isInternal is not true we require ACL_TRIGGER permissions on the
     152              :  * relation, as well as ACL_EXECUTE on the trigger function.  For internal
     153              :  * triggers the caller must apply any required permission checks.
     154              :  *
     155              :  * When called on partitioned tables, this function recurses to create the
     156              :  * trigger on all the partitions, except if isInternal is true, in which
     157              :  * case caller is expected to execute recursion on its own.  in_partition
     158              :  * indicates such a recursive call; outside callers should pass "false"
     159              :  * (but see CloneRowTriggersToPartition).
     160              :  */
     161              : ObjectAddress
     162        10998 : CreateTrigger(const CreateTrigStmt *stmt, const char *queryString,
     163              :               Oid relOid, Oid refRelOid, Oid constraintOid, Oid indexOid,
     164              :               Oid funcoid, Oid parentTriggerOid, Node *whenClause,
     165              :               bool isInternal, bool in_partition)
     166              : {
     167              :     return
     168        10998 :         CreateTriggerFiringOn(stmt, queryString, relOid, refRelOid,
     169              :                               constraintOid, indexOid, funcoid,
     170              :                               parentTriggerOid, whenClause, isInternal,
     171              :                               in_partition, TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_ORIGIN);
     172              : }
     173              : 
     174              : /*
     175              :  * Like the above; additionally the firing condition
     176              :  * (always/origin/replica/disabled) can be specified.
     177              :  */
     178              : ObjectAddress
     179        11601 : CreateTriggerFiringOn(const CreateTrigStmt *stmt, const char *queryString,
     180              :                       Oid relOid, Oid refRelOid, Oid constraintOid,
     181              :                       Oid indexOid, Oid funcoid, Oid parentTriggerOid,
     182              :                       Node *whenClause, bool isInternal, bool in_partition,
     183              :                       char trigger_fires_when)
     184              : {
     185              :     int16       tgtype;
     186              :     int         ncolumns;
     187              :     int16      *columns;
     188              :     int2vector *tgattr;
     189              :     List       *whenRtable;
     190              :     char       *qual;
     191              :     Datum       values[Natts_pg_trigger];
     192              :     bool        nulls[Natts_pg_trigger];
     193              :     Relation    rel;
     194              :     AclResult   aclresult;
     195              :     Relation    tgrel;
     196              :     Relation    pgrel;
     197        11601 :     HeapTuple   tuple = NULL;
     198              :     Oid         funcrettype;
     199        11601 :     Oid         trigoid = InvalidOid;
     200              :     char        internaltrigname[NAMEDATALEN];
     201              :     char       *trigname;
     202        11601 :     Oid         constrrelid = InvalidOid;
     203              :     ObjectAddress myself,
     204              :                 referenced;
     205        11601 :     char       *oldtablename = NULL;
     206        11601 :     char       *newtablename = NULL;
     207              :     bool        partition_recurse;
     208        11601 :     bool        trigger_exists = false;
     209        11601 :     Oid         existing_constraint_oid = InvalidOid;
     210        11601 :     bool        existing_isInternal = false;
     211        11601 :     bool        existing_isClone = false;
     212              : 
     213        11601 :     if (OidIsValid(relOid))
     214         9483 :         rel = table_open(relOid, ShareRowExclusiveLock);
     215              :     else
     216         2118 :         rel = table_openrv(stmt->relation, ShareRowExclusiveLock);
     217              : 
     218              :     /*
     219              :      * Triggers must be on tables or views, and there are additional
     220              :      * relation-type-specific restrictions.
     221              :      */
     222        11601 :     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_RELATION)
     223              :     {
     224              :         /* Tables can't have INSTEAD OF triggers */
     225         9533 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     226         8670 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     227           12 :             ereport(ERROR,
     228              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     229              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a table",
     230              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     231              :                      errdetail("Tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     232              :     }
     233         2068 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
     234              :     {
     235              :         /* Partitioned tables can't have INSTEAD OF triggers */
     236         1871 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     237         1795 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     238            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     239              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     240              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a table",
     241              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     242              :                      errdetail("Tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     243              : 
     244              :         /*
     245              :          * FOR EACH ROW triggers have further restrictions
     246              :          */
     247         1867 :         if (stmt->row)
     248              :         {
     249              :             /*
     250              :              * Disallow use of transition tables.
     251              :              *
     252              :              * Note that we have another restriction about transition tables
     253              :              * in partitions; search for 'has_superclass' below for an
     254              :              * explanation.  The check here is just to protect from the fact
     255              :              * that if we allowed it here, the creation would succeed for a
     256              :              * partitioned table with no partitions, but would be blocked by
     257              :              * the other restriction when the first partition was created,
     258              :              * which is very unfriendly behavior.
     259              :              */
     260         1703 :             if (stmt->transitionRels != NIL)
     261            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     262              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     263              :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a partitioned table",
     264              :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     265              :                          errdetail("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on partitioned tables.")));
     266              :         }
     267              :     }
     268          197 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_VIEW)
     269              :     {
     270              :         /*
     271              :          * Views can have INSTEAD OF triggers (which we check below are
     272              :          * row-level), or statement-level BEFORE/AFTER triggers.
     273              :          */
     274          139 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD && stmt->row)
     275           24 :             ereport(ERROR,
     276              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     277              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     278              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     279              :                      errdetail("Views cannot have row-level BEFORE or AFTER triggers.")));
     280              :         /* Disallow TRUNCATE triggers on VIEWs */
     281          115 :         if (TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(stmt->events))
     282            8 :             ereport(ERROR,
     283              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     284              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     285              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     286              :                      errdetail("Views cannot have TRUNCATE triggers.")));
     287              :     }
     288           58 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
     289              :     {
     290           58 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     291           31 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     292            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     293              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     294              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     295              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     296              :                      errdetail("Foreign tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     297              : 
     298              :         /*
     299              :          * We disallow constraint triggers to protect the assumption that
     300              :          * triggers on FKs can't be deferred.  See notes with AfterTriggers
     301              :          * data structures, below.
     302              :          */
     303           58 :         if (stmt->isconstraint)
     304            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     305              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     306              :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     307              :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     308              :                      errdetail("Foreign tables cannot have constraint triggers.")));
     309              :     }
     310              :     else
     311            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     312              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     313              :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
     314              :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     315              :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(rel->rd_rel->relkind)));
     316              : 
     317        11545 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemRelation(rel))
     318            1 :         ereport(ERROR,
     319              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
     320              :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
     321              :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     322              : 
     323        11544 :     if (stmt->isconstraint)
     324              :     {
     325              :         /*
     326              :          * We must take a lock on the target relation to protect against
     327              :          * concurrent drop.  It's not clear that AccessShareLock is strong
     328              :          * enough, but we certainly need at least that much... otherwise, we
     329              :          * might end up creating a pg_constraint entry referencing a
     330              :          * nonexistent table.
     331              :          */
     332         8997 :         if (OidIsValid(refRelOid))
     333              :         {
     334         8806 :             LockRelationOid(refRelOid, AccessShareLock);
     335         8806 :             constrrelid = refRelOid;
     336              :         }
     337          191 :         else if (stmt->constrrel != NULL)
     338           16 :             constrrelid = RangeVarGetRelid(stmt->constrrel, AccessShareLock,
     339              :                                            false);
     340              :     }
     341              : 
     342              :     /* permission checks */
     343        11544 :     if (!isInternal)
     344              :     {
     345         2664 :         aclresult = pg_class_aclcheck(RelationGetRelid(rel), GetUserId(),
     346              :                                       ACL_TRIGGER);
     347         2664 :         if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     348            0 :             aclcheck_error(aclresult, get_relkind_objtype(rel->rd_rel->relkind),
     349            0 :                            RelationGetRelationName(rel));
     350              : 
     351         2664 :         if (OidIsValid(constrrelid))
     352              :         {
     353           28 :             aclresult = pg_class_aclcheck(constrrelid, GetUserId(),
     354              :                                           ACL_TRIGGER);
     355           28 :             if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     356            0 :                 aclcheck_error(aclresult, get_relkind_objtype(get_rel_relkind(constrrelid)),
     357            0 :                                get_rel_name(constrrelid));
     358              :         }
     359              :     }
     360              : 
     361              :     /*
     362              :      * When called on a partitioned table to create a FOR EACH ROW trigger
     363              :      * that's not internal, we create one trigger for each partition, too.
     364              :      *
     365              :      * For that, we'd better hold lock on all of them ahead of time.
     366              :      */
     367        13519 :     partition_recurse = !isInternal && stmt->row &&
     368         1975 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE;
     369        11544 :     if (partition_recurse)
     370          279 :         list_free(find_all_inheritors(RelationGetRelid(rel),
     371              :                                       ShareRowExclusiveLock, NULL));
     372              : 
     373              :     /* Compute tgtype */
     374        11544 :     TRIGGER_CLEAR_TYPE(tgtype);
     375        11544 :     if (stmt->row)
     376        10855 :         TRIGGER_SETT_ROW(tgtype);
     377        11544 :     tgtype |= stmt->timing;
     378        11544 :     tgtype |= stmt->events;
     379              : 
     380              :     /* Disallow ROW-level TRUNCATE triggers */
     381        11544 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype) && TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(tgtype))
     382            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     383              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     384              :                  errmsg("TRUNCATE FOR EACH ROW triggers are not supported")));
     385              : 
     386              :     /* INSTEAD triggers must be row-level, and can't have WHEN or columns */
     387        11544 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_INSTEAD(tgtype))
     388              :     {
     389           79 :         if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     390            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     391              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     392              :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers must be FOR EACH ROW")));
     393           75 :         if (stmt->whenClause)
     394            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     395              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     396              :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers cannot have WHEN conditions")));
     397           71 :         if (stmt->columns != NIL)
     398            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     399              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     400              :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers cannot have column lists")));
     401              :     }
     402              : 
     403              :     /*
     404              :      * We don't yet support naming ROW transition variables, but the parser
     405              :      * recognizes the syntax so we can give a nicer message here.
     406              :      *
     407              :      * Per standard, REFERENCING TABLE names are only allowed on AFTER
     408              :      * triggers.  Per standard, REFERENCING ROW names are not allowed with FOR
     409              :      * EACH STATEMENT.  Per standard, each OLD/NEW, ROW/TABLE permutation is
     410              :      * only allowed once.  Per standard, OLD may not be specified when
     411              :      * creating a trigger only for INSERT, and NEW may not be specified when
     412              :      * creating a trigger only for DELETE.
     413              :      *
     414              :      * Notice that the standard allows an AFTER ... FOR EACH ROW trigger to
     415              :      * reference both ROW and TABLE transition data.
     416              :      */
     417        11532 :     if (stmt->transitionRels != NIL)
     418              :     {
     419          324 :         List       *varList = stmt->transitionRels;
     420              :         ListCell   *lc;
     421              : 
     422          708 :         foreach(lc, varList)
     423              :         {
     424          416 :             TriggerTransition *tt = lfirst_node(TriggerTransition, lc);
     425              : 
     426          416 :             if (!(tt->isTable))
     427            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     428              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     429              :                          errmsg("ROW variable naming in the REFERENCING clause is not supported"),
     430              :                          errhint("Use OLD TABLE or NEW TABLE for naming transition tables.")));
     431              : 
     432              :             /*
     433              :              * Because of the above test, we omit further ROW-related testing
     434              :              * below.  If we later allow naming OLD and NEW ROW variables,
     435              :              * adjustments will be needed below.
     436              :              */
     437              : 
     438          416 :             if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
     439            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     440              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     441              :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     442              :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     443              :                          errdetail("Triggers on foreign tables cannot have transition tables.")));
     444              : 
     445          412 :             if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_VIEW)
     446            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     447              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     448              :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     449              :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     450              :                          errdetail("Triggers on views cannot have transition tables.")));
     451              : 
     452              :             /*
     453              :              * We currently don't allow row-level triggers with transition
     454              :              * tables on partition or inheritance children.  Such triggers
     455              :              * would somehow need to see tuples converted to the format of the
     456              :              * table they're attached to, and it's not clear which subset of
     457              :              * tuples each child should see.  See also the prohibitions in
     458              :              * ATExecAttachPartition() and ATExecAddInherit().
     459              :              */
     460          408 :             if (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype) && has_superclass(rel->rd_id))
     461              :             {
     462              :                 /* Use appropriate error message. */
     463            8 :                 if (rel->rd_rel->relispartition)
     464            4 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     465              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     466              :                              errmsg("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on partitions")));
     467              :                 else
     468            4 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     469              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     470              :                              errmsg("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on inheritance children")));
     471              :             }
     472              : 
     473          400 :             if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     474            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     475              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     476              :                          errmsg("transition table name can only be specified for an AFTER trigger")));
     477              : 
     478          400 :             if (TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(tgtype))
     479            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     480              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     481              :                          errmsg("TRUNCATE triggers with transition tables are not supported")));
     482              : 
     483              :             /*
     484              :              * We currently don't allow multi-event triggers ("INSERT OR
     485              :              * UPDATE") with transition tables, because it's not clear how to
     486              :              * handle INSERT ... ON CONFLICT statements which can fire both
     487              :              * INSERT and UPDATE triggers.  We show the inserted tuples to
     488              :              * INSERT triggers and the updated tuples to UPDATE triggers, but
     489              :              * it's not yet clear what INSERT OR UPDATE trigger should see.
     490              :              * This restriction could be lifted if we can decide on the right
     491              :              * semantics in a later release.
     492              :              */
     493          396 :             if (((TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) ? 1 : 0) +
     494          396 :                  (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) ? 1 : 0) +
     495          396 :                  (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) ? 1 : 0)) != 1)
     496            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     497              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     498              :                          errmsg("transition tables cannot be specified for triggers with more than one event")));
     499              : 
     500              :             /*
     501              :              * We currently don't allow column-specific triggers with
     502              :              * transition tables.  Per spec, that seems to require
     503              :              * accumulating separate transition tables for each combination of
     504              :              * columns, which is a lot of work for a rather marginal feature.
     505              :              */
     506          392 :             if (stmt->columns != NIL)
     507            4 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     508              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     509              :                          errmsg("transition tables cannot be specified for triggers with column lists")));
     510              : 
     511              :             /*
     512              :              * We disallow constraint triggers with transition tables, to
     513              :              * protect the assumption that such triggers can't be deferred.
     514              :              * See notes with AfterTriggers data structures, below.
     515              :              *
     516              :              * Currently this is enforced by the grammar, so just Assert here.
     517              :              */
     518              :             Assert(!stmt->isconstraint);
     519              : 
     520          388 :             if (tt->isNew)
     521              :             {
     522          204 :                 if (!(TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) ||
     523          109 :                       TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype)))
     524            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     525              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     526              :                              errmsg("NEW TABLE can only be specified for an INSERT or UPDATE trigger")));
     527              : 
     528          204 :                 if (newtablename != NULL)
     529            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     530              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     531              :                              errmsg("NEW TABLE cannot be specified multiple times")));
     532              : 
     533          204 :                 newtablename = tt->name;
     534              :             }
     535              :             else
     536              :             {
     537          184 :                 if (!(TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) ||
     538          105 :                       TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype)))
     539            4 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     540              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     541              :                              errmsg("OLD TABLE can only be specified for a DELETE or UPDATE trigger")));
     542              : 
     543          180 :                 if (oldtablename != NULL)
     544            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     545              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     546              :                              errmsg("OLD TABLE cannot be specified multiple times")));
     547              : 
     548          180 :                 oldtablename = tt->name;
     549              :             }
     550              :         }
     551              : 
     552          292 :         if (newtablename != NULL && oldtablename != NULL &&
     553           92 :             strcmp(newtablename, oldtablename) == 0)
     554            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     555              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     556              :                      errmsg("OLD TABLE name and NEW TABLE name cannot be the same")));
     557              :     }
     558              : 
     559              :     /*
     560              :      * Parse the WHEN clause, if any and we weren't passed an already
     561              :      * transformed one.
     562              :      *
     563              :      * Note that as a side effect, we fill whenRtable when parsing.  If we got
     564              :      * an already parsed clause, this does not occur, which is what we want --
     565              :      * no point in adding redundant dependencies below.
     566              :      */
     567        11500 :     if (!whenClause && stmt->whenClause)
     568           88 :     {
     569              :         ParseState *pstate;
     570              :         ParseNamespaceItem *nsitem;
     571              :         List       *varList;
     572              :         ListCell   *lc;
     573              : 
     574              :         /* Set up a pstate to parse with */
     575          120 :         pstate = make_parsestate(NULL);
     576          120 :         pstate->p_sourcetext = queryString;
     577              : 
     578              :         /*
     579              :          * Set up nsitems for OLD and NEW references.
     580              :          *
     581              :          * 'OLD' must always have varno equal to 1 and 'NEW' equal to 2.
     582              :          */
     583          120 :         nsitem = addRangeTableEntryForRelation(pstate, rel,
     584              :                                                AccessShareLock,
     585              :                                                makeAlias("old", NIL),
     586              :                                                false, false);
     587          120 :         addNSItemToQuery(pstate, nsitem, false, true, true);
     588          120 :         nsitem = addRangeTableEntryForRelation(pstate, rel,
     589              :                                                AccessShareLock,
     590              :                                                makeAlias("new", NIL),
     591              :                                                false, false);
     592          120 :         addNSItemToQuery(pstate, nsitem, false, true, true);
     593              : 
     594              :         /* Transform expression.  Copy to be sure we don't modify original */
     595          120 :         whenClause = transformWhereClause(pstate,
     596          120 :                                           copyObject(stmt->whenClause),
     597              :                                           EXPR_KIND_TRIGGER_WHEN,
     598              :                                           "WHEN");
     599              :         /* we have to fix its collations too */
     600          120 :         assign_expr_collations(pstate, whenClause);
     601              : 
     602              :         /*
     603              :          * Check for disallowed references to OLD/NEW.
     604              :          *
     605              :          * NB: pull_var_clause is okay here only because we don't allow
     606              :          * subselects in WHEN clauses; it would fail to examine the contents
     607              :          * of subselects.
     608              :          */
     609          120 :         varList = pull_var_clause(whenClause, 0);
     610          237 :         foreach(lc, varList)
     611              :         {
     612          149 :             Var        *var = (Var *) lfirst(lc);
     613              : 
     614          149 :             switch (var->varno)
     615              :             {
     616           56 :                 case PRS2_OLD_VARNO:
     617           56 :                     if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     618            4 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     619              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     620              :                                  errmsg("statement trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference column values"),
     621              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     622           52 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype))
     623            4 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     624              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     625              :                                  errmsg("INSERT trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference OLD values"),
     626              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     627              :                     /* system columns are okay here */
     628           48 :                     break;
     629           93 :                 case PRS2_NEW_VARNO:
     630           93 :                     if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     631            0 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     632              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     633              :                                  errmsg("statement trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference column values"),
     634              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     635           93 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype))
     636            4 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     637              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     638              :                                  errmsg("DELETE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW values"),
     639              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     640           89 :                     if (var->varattno < 0 && TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype))
     641            4 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     642              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     643              :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW system columns"),
     644              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     645           85 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype) &&
     646           34 :                         var->varattno == 0 &&
     647           12 :                         RelationGetDescr(rel)->constr &&
     648            8 :                         (RelationGetDescr(rel)->constr->has_generated_stored ||
     649            4 :                          RelationGetDescr(rel)->constr->has_generated_virtual))
     650            8 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     651              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     652              :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW generated columns"),
     653              :                                  errdetail("A whole-row reference is used and the table contains generated columns."),
     654              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     655           77 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype) &&
     656           26 :                         var->varattno > 0 &&
     657           22 :                         TupleDescAttr(RelationGetDescr(rel), var->varattno - 1)->attgenerated)
     658            8 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     659              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     660              :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW generated columns"),
     661              :                                  errdetail("Column \"%s\" is a generated column.",
     662              :                                            NameStr(TupleDescAttr(RelationGetDescr(rel), var->varattno - 1)->attname)),
     663              :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     664           69 :                     break;
     665            0 :                 default:
     666              :                     /* can't happen without add_missing_from, so just elog */
     667            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "trigger WHEN condition cannot contain references to other relations");
     668              :                     break;
     669              :             }
     670              :         }
     671              : 
     672              :         /* we'll need the rtable for recordDependencyOnExpr */
     673           88 :         whenRtable = pstate->p_rtable;
     674              : 
     675           88 :         qual = nodeToString(whenClause);
     676              : 
     677           88 :         free_parsestate(pstate);
     678              :     }
     679        11380 :     else if (!whenClause)
     680              :     {
     681        11352 :         whenClause = NULL;
     682        11352 :         whenRtable = NIL;
     683        11352 :         qual = NULL;
     684              :     }
     685              :     else
     686              :     {
     687           28 :         qual = nodeToString(whenClause);
     688           28 :         whenRtable = NIL;
     689              :     }
     690              : 
     691              :     /*
     692              :      * Find and validate the trigger function.
     693              :      */
     694        11468 :     if (!OidIsValid(funcoid))
     695        10865 :         funcoid = LookupFuncName(stmt->funcname, 0, NULL, false);
     696        11468 :     if (!isInternal)
     697              :     {
     698         2588 :         aclresult = object_aclcheck(ProcedureRelationId, funcoid, GetUserId(), ACL_EXECUTE);
     699         2588 :         if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     700            0 :             aclcheck_error(aclresult, OBJECT_FUNCTION,
     701            0 :                            NameListToString(stmt->funcname));
     702              :     }
     703        11468 :     funcrettype = get_func_rettype(funcoid);
     704        11468 :     if (funcrettype != TRIGGEROID)
     705            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     706              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     707              :                  errmsg("function %s must return type %s",
     708              :                         NameListToString(stmt->funcname), "trigger")));
     709              : 
     710              :     /*
     711              :      * Scan pg_trigger to see if there is already a trigger of the same name.
     712              :      * Skip this for internally generated triggers, since we'll modify the
     713              :      * name to be unique below.
     714              :      *
     715              :      * NOTE that this is cool only because we have ShareRowExclusiveLock on
     716              :      * the relation, so the trigger set won't be changing underneath us.
     717              :      */
     718        11468 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
     719        11468 :     if (!isInternal)
     720              :     {
     721              :         ScanKeyData skeys[2];
     722              :         SysScanDesc tgscan;
     723              : 
     724         2588 :         ScanKeyInit(&skeys[0],
     725              :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
     726              :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
     727              :                     ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
     728              : 
     729         2588 :         ScanKeyInit(&skeys[1],
     730              :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
     731              :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
     732         2588 :                     CStringGetDatum(stmt->trigname));
     733              : 
     734         2588 :         tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
     735              :                                     NULL, 2, skeys);
     736              : 
     737              :         /* There should be at most one matching tuple */
     738         2588 :         if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
     739              :         {
     740           68 :             Form_pg_trigger oldtrigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
     741              : 
     742           68 :             trigoid = oldtrigger->oid;
     743           68 :             existing_constraint_oid = oldtrigger->tgconstraint;
     744           68 :             existing_isInternal = oldtrigger->tgisinternal;
     745           68 :             existing_isClone = OidIsValid(oldtrigger->tgparentid);
     746           68 :             trigger_exists = true;
     747              :             /* copy the tuple to use in CatalogTupleUpdate() */
     748           68 :             tuple = heap_copytuple(tuple);
     749              :         }
     750         2588 :         systable_endscan(tgscan);
     751              :     }
     752              : 
     753        11468 :     if (!trigger_exists)
     754              :     {
     755              :         /* Generate the OID for the new trigger. */
     756        11400 :         trigoid = GetNewOidWithIndex(tgrel, TriggerOidIndexId,
     757              :                                      Anum_pg_trigger_oid);
     758              :     }
     759              :     else
     760              :     {
     761              :         /*
     762              :          * If OR REPLACE was specified, we'll replace the old trigger;
     763              :          * otherwise complain about the duplicate name.
     764              :          */
     765           68 :         if (!stmt->replace)
     766           12 :             ereport(ERROR,
     767              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     768              :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" already exists",
     769              :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     770              : 
     771              :         /*
     772              :          * An internal trigger or a child trigger (isClone) cannot be replaced
     773              :          * by a user-defined trigger.  However, skip this test when
     774              :          * in_partition, because then we're recursing from a partitioned table
     775              :          * and the check was made at the parent level.
     776              :          */
     777           56 :         if ((existing_isInternal || existing_isClone) &&
     778           40 :             !isInternal && !in_partition)
     779            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
     780              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     781              :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" is an internal or a child trigger",
     782              :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     783              : 
     784              :         /*
     785              :          * It is not allowed to replace with a constraint trigger; gram.y
     786              :          * should have enforced this already.
     787              :          */
     788              :         Assert(!stmt->isconstraint);
     789              : 
     790              :         /*
     791              :          * It is not allowed to replace an existing constraint trigger,
     792              :          * either.  (The reason for these restrictions is partly that it seems
     793              :          * difficult to deal with pending trigger events in such cases, and
     794              :          * partly that the command might imply changing the constraint's
     795              :          * properties as well, which doesn't seem nice.)
     796              :          */
     797           52 :         if (OidIsValid(existing_constraint_oid))
     798            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     799              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     800              :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" is a constraint trigger",
     801              :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     802              :     }
     803              : 
     804              :     /*
     805              :      * If it's a user-entered CREATE CONSTRAINT TRIGGER command, make a
     806              :      * corresponding pg_constraint entry.
     807              :      */
     808        11452 :     if (stmt->isconstraint && !OidIsValid(constraintOid))
     809              :     {
     810              :         /* Internal callers should have made their own constraints */
     811              :         Assert(!isInternal);
     812          117 :         constraintOid = CreateConstraintEntry(stmt->trigname,
     813          117 :                                               RelationGetNamespace(rel),
     814              :                                               CONSTRAINT_TRIGGER,
     815          117 :                                               stmt->deferrable,
     816          117 :                                               stmt->initdeferred,
     817              :                                               true, /* Is Enforced */
     818              :                                               true,
     819              :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no parent */
     820              :                                               RelationGetRelid(rel),
     821              :                                               NULL, /* no conkey */
     822              :                                               0,
     823              :                                               0,
     824              :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no domain */
     825              :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no index */
     826              :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no foreign key */
     827              :                                               NULL,
     828              :                                               NULL,
     829              :                                               NULL,
     830              :                                               NULL,
     831              :                                               0,
     832              :                                               ' ',
     833              :                                               ' ',
     834              :                                               NULL,
     835              :                                               0,
     836              :                                               ' ',
     837              :                                               NULL, /* no exclusion */
     838              :                                               NULL, /* no check constraint */
     839              :                                               NULL,
     840              :                                               true, /* islocal */
     841              :                                               0,    /* inhcount */
     842              :                                               true, /* noinherit */
     843              :                                               false,    /* conperiod */
     844              :                                               isInternal);  /* is_internal */
     845              :     }
     846              : 
     847              :     /*
     848              :      * If trigger is internally generated, modify the provided trigger name to
     849              :      * ensure uniqueness by appending the trigger OID.  (Callers will usually
     850              :      * supply a simple constant trigger name in these cases.)
     851              :      */
     852        11452 :     if (isInternal)
     853              :     {
     854         8880 :         snprintf(internaltrigname, sizeof(internaltrigname),
     855         8880 :                  "%s_%u", stmt->trigname, trigoid);
     856         8880 :         trigname = internaltrigname;
     857              :     }
     858              :     else
     859              :     {
     860              :         /* user-defined trigger; use the specified trigger name as-is */
     861         2572 :         trigname = stmt->trigname;
     862              :     }
     863              : 
     864              :     /*
     865              :      * Build the new pg_trigger tuple.
     866              :      */
     867        11452 :     memset(nulls, false, sizeof(nulls));
     868              : 
     869        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_oid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(trigoid);
     870        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel));
     871        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgparentid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(parentTriggerOid);
     872        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgname - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     873              :                                                              CStringGetDatum(trigname));
     874        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgfoid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(funcoid);
     875        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgtype - 1] = Int16GetDatum(tgtype);
     876        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgenabled - 1] = CharGetDatum(trigger_fires_when);
     877        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgisinternal - 1] = BoolGetDatum(isInternal);
     878        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstrrelid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(constrrelid);
     879        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstrindid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(indexOid);
     880        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstraint - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(constraintOid);
     881        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgdeferrable - 1] = BoolGetDatum(stmt->deferrable);
     882        11452 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tginitdeferred - 1] = BoolGetDatum(stmt->initdeferred);
     883              : 
     884        11452 :     if (stmt->args)
     885              :     {
     886              :         ListCell   *le;
     887              :         char       *args;
     888          457 :         int16       nargs = list_length(stmt->args);
     889          457 :         int         len = 0;
     890              : 
     891         1088 :         foreach(le, stmt->args)
     892              :         {
     893          631 :             char       *ar = strVal(lfirst(le));
     894              : 
     895          631 :             len += strlen(ar) + 4;
     896         4992 :             for (; *ar; ar++)
     897              :             {
     898         4361 :                 if (*ar == '\\')
     899            0 :                     len++;
     900              :             }
     901              :         }
     902          457 :         args = (char *) palloc(len + 1);
     903          457 :         args[0] = '\0';
     904         1088 :         foreach(le, stmt->args)
     905              :         {
     906          631 :             char       *s = strVal(lfirst(le));
     907          631 :             char       *d = args + strlen(args);
     908              : 
     909         4992 :             while (*s)
     910              :             {
     911         4361 :                 if (*s == '\\')
     912            0 :                     *d++ = '\\';
     913         4361 :                 *d++ = *s++;
     914              :             }
     915          631 :             strcpy(d, "\\000");
     916              :         }
     917          457 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnargs - 1] = Int16GetDatum(nargs);
     918          457 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(byteain,
     919              :                                                                  CStringGetDatum(args));
     920              :     }
     921              :     else
     922              :     {
     923        10995 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnargs - 1] = Int16GetDatum(0);
     924        10995 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(byteain,
     925              :                                                                  CStringGetDatum(""));
     926              :     }
     927              : 
     928              :     /* build column number array if it's a column-specific trigger */
     929        11452 :     ncolumns = list_length(stmt->columns);
     930        11452 :     if (ncolumns == 0)
     931        11383 :         columns = NULL;
     932              :     else
     933              :     {
     934              :         ListCell   *cell;
     935           69 :         int         i = 0;
     936              : 
     937           69 :         columns = (int16 *) palloc(ncolumns * sizeof(int16));
     938          143 :         foreach(cell, stmt->columns)
     939              :         {
     940           78 :             char       *name = strVal(lfirst(cell));
     941              :             int16       attnum;
     942              :             int         j;
     943              : 
     944              :             /* Lookup column name.  System columns are not allowed */
     945           78 :             attnum = attnameAttNum(rel, name, false);
     946           78 :             if (attnum == InvalidAttrNumber)
     947            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     948              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_COLUMN),
     949              :                          errmsg("column \"%s\" of relation \"%s\" does not exist",
     950              :                                 name, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     951              : 
     952              :             /* Check for duplicates */
     953           83 :             for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j--)
     954              :             {
     955            9 :                 if (columns[j] == attnum)
     956            4 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     957              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_COLUMN),
     958              :                              errmsg("column \"%s\" specified more than once",
     959              :                                     name)));
     960              :             }
     961              : 
     962           74 :             columns[i++] = attnum;
     963              :         }
     964              :     }
     965        11448 :     tgattr = buildint2vector(columns, ncolumns);
     966        11448 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgattr - 1] = PointerGetDatum(tgattr);
     967              : 
     968              :     /* set tgqual if trigger has WHEN clause */
     969        11448 :     if (qual)
     970          116 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual - 1] = CStringGetTextDatum(qual);
     971              :     else
     972        11332 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual - 1] = true;
     973              : 
     974        11448 :     if (oldtablename)
     975          180 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     976              :                                                                      CStringGetDatum(oldtablename));
     977              :     else
     978        11268 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1] = true;
     979        11448 :     if (newtablename)
     980          204 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     981              :                                                                      CStringGetDatum(newtablename));
     982              :     else
     983        11244 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1] = true;
     984              : 
     985              :     /*
     986              :      * Insert or replace tuple in pg_trigger.
     987              :      */
     988        11448 :     if (!trigger_exists)
     989              :     {
     990        11396 :         tuple = heap_form_tuple(tgrel->rd_att, values, nulls);
     991        11396 :         CatalogTupleInsert(tgrel, tuple);
     992              :     }
     993              :     else
     994              :     {
     995              :         HeapTuple   newtup;
     996              : 
     997           52 :         newtup = heap_form_tuple(tgrel->rd_att, values, nulls);
     998           52 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
     999           52 :         heap_freetuple(newtup);
    1000              :     }
    1001              : 
    1002        11448 :     heap_freetuple(tuple);      /* free either original or new tuple */
    1003        11448 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1004              : 
    1005        11448 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgname - 1]));
    1006        11448 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1]));
    1007        11448 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgattr - 1]));
    1008        11448 :     if (oldtablename)
    1009          180 :         pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1]));
    1010        11448 :     if (newtablename)
    1011          204 :         pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1]));
    1012              : 
    1013              :     /*
    1014              :      * Update relation's pg_class entry; if necessary; and if not, send an SI
    1015              :      * message to make other backends (and this one) rebuild relcache entries.
    1016              :      */
    1017        11448 :     pgrel = table_open(RelationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1018        11448 :     tuple = SearchSysCacheCopy1(RELOID,
    1019              :                                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
    1020        11448 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1021            0 :         elog(ERROR, "cache lookup failed for relation %u",
    1022              :              RelationGetRelid(rel));
    1023        11448 :     if (!((Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple))->relhastriggers)
    1024              :     {
    1025         4257 :         ((Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple))->relhastriggers = true;
    1026              : 
    1027         4257 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(pgrel, &tuple->t_self, tuple);
    1028              : 
    1029         4257 :         CommandCounterIncrement();
    1030              :     }
    1031              :     else
    1032         7191 :         CacheInvalidateRelcacheByTuple(tuple);
    1033              : 
    1034        11448 :     heap_freetuple(tuple);
    1035        11448 :     table_close(pgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1036              : 
    1037              :     /*
    1038              :      * If we're replacing a trigger, flush all the old dependencies before
    1039              :      * recording new ones.
    1040              :      */
    1041        11448 :     if (trigger_exists)
    1042           52 :         deleteDependencyRecordsFor(TriggerRelationId, trigoid, true);
    1043              : 
    1044              :     /*
    1045              :      * Record dependencies for trigger.  Always place a normal dependency on
    1046              :      * the function.
    1047              :      */
    1048        11448 :     myself.classId = TriggerRelationId;
    1049        11448 :     myself.objectId = trigoid;
    1050        11448 :     myself.objectSubId = 0;
    1051              : 
    1052        11448 :     referenced.classId = ProcedureRelationId;
    1053        11448 :     referenced.objectId = funcoid;
    1054        11448 :     referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1055        11448 :     recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1056              : 
    1057        11448 :     if (isInternal && OidIsValid(constraintOid))
    1058              :     {
    1059              :         /*
    1060              :          * Internally-generated trigger for a constraint, so make it an
    1061              :          * internal dependency of the constraint.  We can skip depending on
    1062              :          * the relation(s), as there'll be an indirect dependency via the
    1063              :          * constraint.
    1064              :          */
    1065         8880 :         referenced.classId = ConstraintRelationId;
    1066         8880 :         referenced.objectId = constraintOid;
    1067         8880 :         referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1068         8880 :         recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_INTERNAL);
    1069              :     }
    1070              :     else
    1071              :     {
    1072              :         /*
    1073              :          * User CREATE TRIGGER, so place dependencies.  We make trigger be
    1074              :          * auto-dropped if its relation is dropped or if the FK relation is
    1075              :          * dropped.  (Auto drop is compatible with our pre-7.3 behavior.)
    1076              :          */
    1077         2568 :         referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1078         2568 :         referenced.objectId = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    1079         2568 :         referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1080         2568 :         recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_AUTO);
    1081              : 
    1082         2568 :         if (OidIsValid(constrrelid))
    1083              :         {
    1084           28 :             referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1085           28 :             referenced.objectId = constrrelid;
    1086           28 :             referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1087           28 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_AUTO);
    1088              :         }
    1089              :         /* Not possible to have an index dependency in this case */
    1090              :         Assert(!OidIsValid(indexOid));
    1091              : 
    1092              :         /*
    1093              :          * If it's a user-specified constraint trigger, make the constraint
    1094              :          * internally dependent on the trigger instead of vice versa.
    1095              :          */
    1096         2568 :         if (OidIsValid(constraintOid))
    1097              :         {
    1098          117 :             referenced.classId = ConstraintRelationId;
    1099          117 :             referenced.objectId = constraintOid;
    1100          117 :             referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1101          117 :             recordDependencyOn(&referenced, &myself, DEPENDENCY_INTERNAL);
    1102              :         }
    1103              : 
    1104              :         /*
    1105              :          * If it's a partition trigger, create the partition dependencies.
    1106              :          */
    1107         2568 :         if (OidIsValid(parentTriggerOid))
    1108              :         {
    1109          595 :             ObjectAddressSet(referenced, TriggerRelationId, parentTriggerOid);
    1110          595 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1111          595 :             ObjectAddressSet(referenced, RelationRelationId, RelationGetRelid(rel));
    1112          595 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1113              :         }
    1114              :     }
    1115              : 
    1116              :     /* If column-specific trigger, add normal dependencies on columns */
    1117        11448 :     if (columns != NULL)
    1118              :     {
    1119              :         int         i;
    1120              : 
    1121           65 :         referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1122           65 :         referenced.objectId = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    1123          135 :         for (i = 0; i < ncolumns; i++)
    1124              :         {
    1125           70 :             referenced.objectSubId = columns[i];
    1126           70 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1127              :         }
    1128              :     }
    1129              : 
    1130              :     /*
    1131              :      * If it has a WHEN clause, add dependencies on objects mentioned in the
    1132              :      * expression (eg, functions, as well as any columns used).
    1133              :      */
    1134        11448 :     if (whenRtable != NIL)
    1135           88 :         recordDependencyOnExpr(&myself, whenClause, whenRtable,
    1136              :                                DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1137              : 
    1138              :     /* Post creation hook for new trigger */
    1139        11448 :     InvokeObjectPostCreateHookArg(TriggerRelationId, trigoid, 0,
    1140              :                                   isInternal);
    1141              : 
    1142              :     /*
    1143              :      * Lastly, create the trigger on child relations, if needed.
    1144              :      */
    1145        11448 :     if (partition_recurse)
    1146              :     {
    1147          271 :         PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(rel, true);
    1148              :         int         i;
    1149              :         MemoryContext oldcxt,
    1150              :                     perChildCxt;
    1151              : 
    1152          271 :         perChildCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(CurrentMemoryContext,
    1153              :                                             "part trig clone",
    1154              :                                             ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
    1155              : 
    1156              :         /*
    1157              :          * We don't currently expect to be called with a valid indexOid.  If
    1158              :          * that ever changes then we'll need to write code here to find the
    1159              :          * corresponding child index.
    1160              :          */
    1161              :         Assert(!OidIsValid(indexOid));
    1162              : 
    1163          271 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(perChildCxt);
    1164              : 
    1165              :         /* Iterate to create the trigger on each existing partition */
    1166          739 :         for (i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1167              :         {
    1168              :             CreateTrigStmt *childStmt;
    1169              :             Relation    childTbl;
    1170              :             Node       *qual;
    1171              : 
    1172          472 :             childTbl = table_open(partdesc->oids[i], ShareRowExclusiveLock);
    1173              : 
    1174              :             /*
    1175              :              * Initialize our fabricated parse node by copying the original
    1176              :              * one, then resetting fields that we pass separately.
    1177              :              */
    1178          472 :             childStmt = copyObject(stmt);
    1179          472 :             childStmt->funcname = NIL;
    1180          472 :             childStmt->whenClause = NULL;
    1181              : 
    1182              :             /* If there is a WHEN clause, create a modified copy of it */
    1183          472 :             qual = copyObject(whenClause);
    1184              :             qual = (Node *)
    1185          472 :                 map_partition_varattnos((List *) qual, PRS2_OLD_VARNO,
    1186              :                                         childTbl, rel);
    1187              :             qual = (Node *)
    1188          472 :                 map_partition_varattnos((List *) qual, PRS2_NEW_VARNO,
    1189              :                                         childTbl, rel);
    1190              : 
    1191          472 :             CreateTriggerFiringOn(childStmt, queryString,
    1192          472 :                                   partdesc->oids[i], refRelOid,
    1193              :                                   InvalidOid, InvalidOid,
    1194              :                                   funcoid, trigoid, qual,
    1195              :                                   isInternal, true, trigger_fires_when);
    1196              : 
    1197          468 :             table_close(childTbl, NoLock);
    1198              : 
    1199          468 :             MemoryContextReset(perChildCxt);
    1200              :         }
    1201              : 
    1202          267 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    1203          267 :         MemoryContextDelete(perChildCxt);
    1204              :     }
    1205              : 
    1206              :     /* Keep lock on target rel until end of xact */
    1207        11444 :     table_close(rel, NoLock);
    1208              : 
    1209        11444 :     return myself;
    1210              : }
    1211              : 
    1212              : /*
    1213              :  * TriggerSetParentTrigger
    1214              :  *      Set a partition's trigger as child of its parent trigger,
    1215              :  *      or remove the linkage if parentTrigId is InvalidOid.
    1216              :  *
    1217              :  * This updates the constraint's pg_trigger row to show it as inherited, and
    1218              :  * adds PARTITION dependencies to prevent the trigger from being deleted
    1219              :  * on its own.  Alternatively, reverse that.
    1220              :  */
    1221              : void
    1222          344 : TriggerSetParentTrigger(Relation trigRel,
    1223              :                         Oid childTrigId,
    1224              :                         Oid parentTrigId,
    1225              :                         Oid childTableId)
    1226              : {
    1227              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1228              :     ScanKeyData skey[1];
    1229              :     Form_pg_trigger trigForm;
    1230              :     HeapTuple   tuple,
    1231              :                 newtup;
    1232              :     ObjectAddress depender;
    1233              :     ObjectAddress referenced;
    1234              : 
    1235              :     /*
    1236              :      * Find the trigger to delete.
    1237              :      */
    1238          344 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1239              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_oid,
    1240              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1241              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(childTrigId));
    1242              : 
    1243          344 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(trigRel, TriggerOidIndexId, true,
    1244              :                                 NULL, 1, skey);
    1245              : 
    1246          344 :     tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1247          344 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1248            0 :         elog(ERROR, "could not find tuple for trigger %u", childTrigId);
    1249          344 :     newtup = heap_copytuple(tuple);
    1250          344 :     trigForm = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    1251          344 :     if (OidIsValid(parentTrigId))
    1252              :     {
    1253              :         /* don't allow setting parent for a constraint that already has one */
    1254          200 :         if (OidIsValid(trigForm->tgparentid))
    1255            0 :             elog(ERROR, "trigger %u already has a parent trigger",
    1256              :                  childTrigId);
    1257              : 
    1258          200 :         trigForm->tgparentid = parentTrigId;
    1259              : 
    1260          200 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(trigRel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
    1261              : 
    1262          200 :         ObjectAddressSet(depender, TriggerRelationId, childTrigId);
    1263              : 
    1264          200 :         ObjectAddressSet(referenced, TriggerRelationId, parentTrigId);
    1265          200 :         recordDependencyOn(&depender, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1266              : 
    1267          200 :         ObjectAddressSet(referenced, RelationRelationId, childTableId);
    1268          200 :         recordDependencyOn(&depender, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1269              :     }
    1270              :     else
    1271              :     {
    1272          144 :         trigForm->tgparentid = InvalidOid;
    1273              : 
    1274          144 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(trigRel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
    1275              : 
    1276          144 :         deleteDependencyRecordsForClass(TriggerRelationId, childTrigId,
    1277              :                                         TriggerRelationId,
    1278              :                                         DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1279          144 :         deleteDependencyRecordsForClass(TriggerRelationId, childTrigId,
    1280              :                                         RelationRelationId,
    1281              :                                         DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1282              :     }
    1283              : 
    1284          344 :     heap_freetuple(newtup);
    1285          344 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1286          344 : }
    1287              : 
    1288              : 
    1289              : /*
    1290              :  * Guts of trigger deletion.
    1291              :  */
    1292              : void
    1293         9753 : RemoveTriggerById(Oid trigOid)
    1294              : {
    1295              :     Relation    tgrel;
    1296              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1297              :     ScanKeyData skey[1];
    1298              :     HeapTuple   tup;
    1299              :     Oid         relid;
    1300              :     Relation    rel;
    1301              : 
    1302         9753 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1303              : 
    1304              :     /*
    1305              :      * Find the trigger to delete.
    1306              :      */
    1307         9753 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1308              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_oid,
    1309              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1310              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(trigOid));
    1311              : 
    1312         9753 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerOidIndexId, true,
    1313              :                                 NULL, 1, skey);
    1314              : 
    1315         9753 :     tup = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1316         9753 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
    1317            0 :         elog(ERROR, "could not find tuple for trigger %u", trigOid);
    1318              : 
    1319              :     /*
    1320              :      * Open and exclusive-lock the relation the trigger belongs to.
    1321              :      */
    1322         9753 :     relid = ((Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tup))->tgrelid;
    1323              : 
    1324         9753 :     rel = table_open(relid, AccessExclusiveLock);
    1325              : 
    1326         9753 :     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION &&
    1327         1763 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_VIEW &&
    1328         1673 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE &&
    1329         1623 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1330            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1331              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    1332              :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
    1333              :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
    1334              :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(rel->rd_rel->relkind)));
    1335              : 
    1336         9753 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemRelation(rel))
    1337            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1338              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1339              :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
    1340              :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
    1341              : 
    1342              :     /*
    1343              :      * Delete the pg_trigger tuple.
    1344              :      */
    1345         9753 :     CatalogTupleDelete(tgrel, &tup->t_self);
    1346              : 
    1347         9753 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1348         9753 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1349              : 
    1350              :     /*
    1351              :      * We do not bother to try to determine whether any other triggers remain,
    1352              :      * which would be needed in order to decide whether it's safe to clear the
    1353              :      * relation's relhastriggers.  (In any case, there might be a concurrent
    1354              :      * process adding new triggers.)  Instead, just force a relcache inval to
    1355              :      * make other backends (and this one too!) rebuild their relcache entries.
    1356              :      * There's no great harm in leaving relhastriggers true even if there are
    1357              :      * no triggers left.
    1358              :      */
    1359         9753 :     CacheInvalidateRelcache(rel);
    1360              : 
    1361              :     /* Keep lock on trigger's rel until end of xact */
    1362         9753 :     table_close(rel, NoLock);
    1363         9753 : }
    1364              : 
    1365              : /*
    1366              :  * get_trigger_oid - Look up a trigger by name to find its OID.
    1367              :  *
    1368              :  * If missing_ok is false, throw an error if trigger not found.  If
    1369              :  * true, just return InvalidOid.
    1370              :  */
    1371              : Oid
    1372          512 : get_trigger_oid(Oid relid, const char *trigname, bool missing_ok)
    1373              : {
    1374              :     Relation    tgrel;
    1375              :     ScanKeyData skey[2];
    1376              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1377              :     HeapTuple   tup;
    1378              :     Oid         oid;
    1379              : 
    1380              :     /*
    1381              :      * Find the trigger, verify permissions, set up object address
    1382              :      */
    1383          512 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    1384              : 
    1385          512 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1386              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1387              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1388              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1389          512 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[1],
    1390              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1391              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1392              :                 CStringGetDatum(trigname));
    1393              : 
    1394          512 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1395              :                                 NULL, 2, skey);
    1396              : 
    1397          512 :     tup = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1398              : 
    1399          512 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
    1400              :     {
    1401           20 :         if (!missing_ok)
    1402           16 :             ereport(ERROR,
    1403              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1404              :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1405              :                             trigname, get_rel_name(relid))));
    1406            4 :         oid = InvalidOid;
    1407              :     }
    1408              :     else
    1409              :     {
    1410          492 :         oid = ((Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tup))->oid;
    1411              :     }
    1412              : 
    1413          496 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1414          496 :     table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    1415          496 :     return oid;
    1416              : }
    1417              : 
    1418              : /*
    1419              :  * Perform permissions and integrity checks before acquiring a relation lock.
    1420              :  */
    1421              : static void
    1422           29 : RangeVarCallbackForRenameTrigger(const RangeVar *rv, Oid relid, Oid oldrelid,
    1423              :                                  void *arg)
    1424              : {
    1425              :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1426              :     Form_pg_class form;
    1427              : 
    1428           29 :     tuple = SearchSysCache1(RELOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1429           29 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1430            0 :         return;                 /* concurrently dropped */
    1431           29 :     form = (Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1432              : 
    1433              :     /* only tables and views can have triggers */
    1434           29 :     if (form->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION && form->relkind != RELKIND_VIEW &&
    1435           18 :         form->relkind != RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE &&
    1436           18 :         form->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1437            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1438              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    1439              :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
    1440              :                         rv->relname),
    1441              :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(form->relkind)));
    1442              : 
    1443              :     /* you must own the table to rename one of its triggers */
    1444           29 :     if (!object_ownercheck(RelationRelationId, relid, GetUserId()))
    1445            0 :         aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, get_relkind_objtype(get_rel_relkind(relid)), rv->relname);
    1446           29 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemClass(relid, form))
    1447            1 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1448              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1449              :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
    1450              :                         rv->relname)));
    1451              : 
    1452           28 :     ReleaseSysCache(tuple);
    1453              : }
    1454              : 
    1455              : /*
    1456              :  *      renametrig      - changes the name of a trigger on a relation
    1457              :  *
    1458              :  *      trigger name is changed in trigger catalog.
    1459              :  *      No record of the previous name is kept.
    1460              :  *
    1461              :  *      get proper relrelation from relation catalog (if not arg)
    1462              :  *      scan trigger catalog
    1463              :  *              for name conflict (within rel)
    1464              :  *              for original trigger (if not arg)
    1465              :  *      modify tgname in trigger tuple
    1466              :  *      update row in catalog
    1467              :  */
    1468              : ObjectAddress
    1469           26 : renametrig(RenameStmt *stmt)
    1470              : {
    1471              :     Oid         tgoid;
    1472              :     Relation    targetrel;
    1473              :     Relation    tgrel;
    1474              :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1475              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1476              :     ScanKeyData key[2];
    1477              :     Oid         relid;
    1478              :     ObjectAddress address;
    1479              : 
    1480              :     /*
    1481              :      * Look up name, check permissions, and acquire lock (which we will NOT
    1482              :      * release until end of transaction).
    1483              :      */
    1484           26 :     relid = RangeVarGetRelidExtended(stmt->relation, AccessExclusiveLock,
    1485              :                                      0,
    1486              :                                      RangeVarCallbackForRenameTrigger,
    1487              :                                      NULL);
    1488              : 
    1489              :     /* Have lock already, so just need to build relcache entry. */
    1490           25 :     targetrel = relation_open(relid, NoLock);
    1491              : 
    1492              :     /*
    1493              :      * On partitioned tables, this operation recurses to partitions.  Lock all
    1494              :      * tables upfront.
    1495              :      */
    1496           25 :     if (targetrel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1497           16 :         (void) find_all_inheritors(relid, AccessExclusiveLock, NULL);
    1498              : 
    1499           25 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1500              : 
    1501              :     /*
    1502              :      * Search for the trigger to modify.
    1503              :      */
    1504           25 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[0],
    1505              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1506              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1507              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1508           25 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[1],
    1509              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1510              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1511           25 :                 PointerGetDatum(stmt->subname));
    1512           25 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1513              :                                 NULL, 2, key);
    1514           25 :     if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1515              :     {
    1516              :         Form_pg_trigger trigform;
    1517              : 
    1518           25 :         trigform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1519           25 :         tgoid = trigform->oid;
    1520              : 
    1521              :         /*
    1522              :          * If the trigger descends from a trigger on a parent partitioned
    1523              :          * table, reject the rename.  We don't allow a trigger in a partition
    1524              :          * to differ in name from that of its parent: that would lead to an
    1525              :          * inconsistency that pg_dump would not reproduce.
    1526              :          */
    1527           25 :         if (OidIsValid(trigform->tgparentid))
    1528            4 :             ereport(ERROR,
    1529              :                     errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    1530              :                     errmsg("cannot rename trigger \"%s\" on table \"%s\"",
    1531              :                            stmt->subname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel)),
    1532              :                     errhint("Rename the trigger on the partitioned table \"%s\" instead.",
    1533              :                             get_rel_name(get_partition_parent(relid, false))));
    1534              : 
    1535              : 
    1536              :         /* Rename the trigger on this relation ... */
    1537           21 :         renametrig_internal(tgrel, targetrel, tuple, stmt->newname,
    1538           21 :                             stmt->subname);
    1539              : 
    1540              :         /* ... and if it is partitioned, recurse to its partitions */
    1541           21 :         if (targetrel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1542              :         {
    1543           12 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(targetrel, true);
    1544              : 
    1545           20 :             for (int i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1546              :             {
    1547           12 :                 Oid         partitionId = partdesc->oids[i];
    1548              : 
    1549           12 :                 renametrig_partition(tgrel, partitionId, trigform->oid,
    1550           12 :                                      stmt->newname, stmt->subname);
    1551              :             }
    1552              :         }
    1553              :     }
    1554              :     else
    1555              :     {
    1556            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1557              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1558              :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1559              :                         stmt->subname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel))));
    1560              :     }
    1561              : 
    1562           17 :     ObjectAddressSet(address, TriggerRelationId, tgoid);
    1563              : 
    1564           17 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1565              : 
    1566           17 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1567              : 
    1568              :     /*
    1569              :      * Close rel, but keep exclusive lock!
    1570              :      */
    1571           17 :     relation_close(targetrel, NoLock);
    1572              : 
    1573           17 :     return address;
    1574              : }
    1575              : 
    1576              : /*
    1577              :  * Subroutine for renametrig -- perform the actual work of renaming one
    1578              :  * trigger on one table.
    1579              :  *
    1580              :  * If the trigger has a name different from the expected one, raise a
    1581              :  * NOTICE about it.
    1582              :  */
    1583              : static void
    1584           37 : renametrig_internal(Relation tgrel, Relation targetrel, HeapTuple trigtup,
    1585              :                     const char *newname, const char *expected_name)
    1586              : {
    1587              :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1588              :     Form_pg_trigger tgform;
    1589              :     ScanKeyData key[2];
    1590              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1591              : 
    1592              :     /* If the trigger already has the new name, nothing to do. */
    1593           37 :     tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(trigtup);
    1594           37 :     if (strcmp(NameStr(tgform->tgname), newname) == 0)
    1595            0 :         return;
    1596              : 
    1597              :     /*
    1598              :      * Before actually trying the rename, search for triggers with the same
    1599              :      * name.  The update would fail with an ugly message in that case, and it
    1600              :      * is better to throw a nicer error.
    1601              :      */
    1602           37 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[0],
    1603              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1604              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1605              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(targetrel)));
    1606           37 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[1],
    1607              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1608              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1609              :                 PointerGetDatum(newname));
    1610           37 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1611              :                                 NULL, 2, key);
    1612           37 :     if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1613            4 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1614              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
    1615              :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" already exists",
    1616              :                         newname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel))));
    1617           33 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1618              : 
    1619              :     /*
    1620              :      * The target name is free; update the existing pg_trigger tuple with it.
    1621              :      */
    1622           33 :     tuple = heap_copytuple(trigtup);    /* need a modifiable copy */
    1623           33 :     tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1624              : 
    1625              :     /*
    1626              :      * If the trigger has a name different from what we expected, let the user
    1627              :      * know. (We can proceed anyway, since we must have reached here following
    1628              :      * a tgparentid link.)
    1629              :      */
    1630           33 :     if (strcmp(NameStr(tgform->tgname), expected_name) != 0)
    1631            0 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    1632              :                 errmsg("renamed trigger \"%s\" on relation \"%s\"",
    1633              :                        NameStr(tgform->tgname),
    1634              :                        RelationGetRelationName(targetrel)));
    1635              : 
    1636           33 :     namestrcpy(&tgform->tgname, newname);
    1637              : 
    1638           33 :     CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &tuple->t_self, tuple);
    1639              : 
    1640           33 :     InvokeObjectPostAlterHook(TriggerRelationId, tgform->oid, 0);
    1641              : 
    1642              :     /*
    1643              :      * Invalidate relation's relcache entry so that other backends (and this
    1644              :      * one too!) are sent SI message to make them rebuild relcache entries.
    1645              :      * (Ideally this should happen automatically...)
    1646              :      */
    1647           33 :     CacheInvalidateRelcache(targetrel);
    1648              : }
    1649              : 
    1650              : /*
    1651              :  * Subroutine for renametrig -- Helper for recursing to partitions when
    1652              :  * renaming triggers on a partitioned table.
    1653              :  */
    1654              : static void
    1655           20 : renametrig_partition(Relation tgrel, Oid partitionId, Oid parentTriggerOid,
    1656              :                      const char *newname, const char *expected_name)
    1657              : {
    1658              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1659              :     ScanKeyData key;
    1660              :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1661              : 
    1662              :     /*
    1663              :      * Given a relation and the OID of a trigger on parent relation, find the
    1664              :      * corresponding trigger in the child and rename that trigger to the given
    1665              :      * name.
    1666              :      */
    1667           20 :     ScanKeyInit(&key,
    1668              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1669              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1670              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(partitionId));
    1671           20 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1672              :                                 NULL, 1, &key);
    1673           32 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1674              :     {
    1675           28 :         Form_pg_trigger tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1676              :         Relation    partitionRel;
    1677              : 
    1678           28 :         if (tgform->tgparentid != parentTriggerOid)
    1679           12 :             continue;           /* not our trigger */
    1680              : 
    1681           16 :         partitionRel = table_open(partitionId, NoLock);
    1682              : 
    1683              :         /* Rename the trigger on this partition */
    1684           16 :         renametrig_internal(tgrel, partitionRel, tuple, newname, expected_name);
    1685              : 
    1686              :         /* And if this relation is partitioned, recurse to its partitions */
    1687           12 :         if (partitionRel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1688              :         {
    1689            4 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(partitionRel,
    1690              :                                                               true);
    1691              : 
    1692           12 :             for (int i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1693              :             {
    1694            8 :                 Oid         partoid = partdesc->oids[i];
    1695              : 
    1696            8 :                 renametrig_partition(tgrel, partoid, tgform->oid, newname,
    1697            8 :                                      NameStr(tgform->tgname));
    1698              :             }
    1699              :         }
    1700           12 :         table_close(partitionRel, NoLock);
    1701              : 
    1702              :         /* There should be at most one matching tuple */
    1703           12 :         break;
    1704              :     }
    1705           16 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1706           16 : }
    1707              : 
    1708              : /*
    1709              :  * EnableDisableTrigger()
    1710              :  *
    1711              :  *  Called by ALTER TABLE ENABLE/DISABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] TRIGGER
    1712              :  *  to change 'tgenabled' field for the specified trigger(s)
    1713              :  *
    1714              :  * rel: relation to process (caller must hold suitable lock on it)
    1715              :  * tgname: name of trigger to process, or NULL to scan all triggers
    1716              :  * tgparent: if not zero, process only triggers with this tgparentid
    1717              :  * fires_when: new value for tgenabled field. In addition to generic
    1718              :  *             enablement/disablement, this also defines when the trigger
    1719              :  *             should be fired in session replication roles.
    1720              :  * skip_system: if true, skip "system" triggers (constraint triggers)
    1721              :  * recurse: if true, recurse to partitions
    1722              :  *
    1723              :  * Caller should have checked permissions for the table; here we also
    1724              :  * enforce that superuser privilege is required to alter the state of
    1725              :  * system triggers
    1726              :  */
    1727              : void
    1728          264 : EnableDisableTrigger(Relation rel, const char *tgname, Oid tgparent,
    1729              :                      char fires_when, bool skip_system, bool recurse,
    1730              :                      LOCKMODE lockmode)
    1731              : {
    1732              :     Relation    tgrel;
    1733              :     int         nkeys;
    1734              :     ScanKeyData keys[2];
    1735              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1736              :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1737              :     bool        found;
    1738              :     bool        changed;
    1739              : 
    1740              :     /* Scan the relevant entries in pg_triggers */
    1741          264 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1742              : 
    1743          264 :     ScanKeyInit(&keys[0],
    1744              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1745              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1746              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
    1747          264 :     if (tgname)
    1748              :     {
    1749          175 :         ScanKeyInit(&keys[1],
    1750              :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1751              :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1752              :                     CStringGetDatum(tgname));
    1753          175 :         nkeys = 2;
    1754              :     }
    1755              :     else
    1756           89 :         nkeys = 1;
    1757              : 
    1758          264 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1759              :                                 NULL, nkeys, keys);
    1760              : 
    1761          264 :     found = changed = false;
    1762              : 
    1763          712 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1764              :     {
    1765          448 :         Form_pg_trigger oldtrig = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1766              : 
    1767          448 :         if (OidIsValid(tgparent) && tgparent != oldtrig->tgparentid)
    1768          128 :             continue;
    1769              : 
    1770          320 :         if (oldtrig->tgisinternal)
    1771              :         {
    1772              :             /* system trigger ... ok to process? */
    1773           48 :             if (skip_system)
    1774            8 :                 continue;
    1775           40 :             if (!superuser())
    1776            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    1777              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1778              :                          errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system trigger",
    1779              :                                 NameStr(oldtrig->tgname))));
    1780              :         }
    1781              : 
    1782          312 :         found = true;
    1783              : 
    1784          312 :         if (oldtrig->tgenabled != fires_when)
    1785              :         {
    1786              :             /* need to change this one ... make a copy to scribble on */
    1787          292 :             HeapTuple   newtup = heap_copytuple(tuple);
    1788          292 :             Form_pg_trigger newtrig = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    1789              : 
    1790          292 :             newtrig->tgenabled = fires_when;
    1791              : 
    1792          292 :             CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &newtup->t_self, newtup);
    1793              : 
    1794          292 :             heap_freetuple(newtup);
    1795              : 
    1796          292 :             changed = true;
    1797              :         }
    1798              : 
    1799              :         /*
    1800              :          * When altering FOR EACH ROW triggers on a partitioned table, do the
    1801              :          * same on the partitions as well, unless ONLY is specified.
    1802              :          *
    1803              :          * Note that we recurse even if we didn't change the trigger above,
    1804              :          * because the partitions' copy of the trigger may have a different
    1805              :          * value of tgenabled than the parent's trigger and thus might need to
    1806              :          * be changed.
    1807              :          */
    1808          312 :         if (recurse &&
    1809          295 :             rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE &&
    1810           57 :             (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(oldtrig->tgtype)))
    1811              :         {
    1812           49 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(rel, true);
    1813              :             int         i;
    1814              : 
    1815          122 :             for (i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1816              :             {
    1817              :                 Relation    part;
    1818              : 
    1819           73 :                 part = relation_open(partdesc->oids[i], lockmode);
    1820              :                 /* Match on child triggers' tgparentid, not their name */
    1821           73 :                 EnableDisableTrigger(part, NULL, oldtrig->oid,
    1822              :                                      fires_when, skip_system, recurse,
    1823              :                                      lockmode);
    1824           73 :                 table_close(part, NoLock);  /* keep lock till commit */
    1825              :             }
    1826              :         }
    1827              : 
    1828          312 :         InvokeObjectPostAlterHook(TriggerRelationId,
    1829              :                                   oldtrig->oid, 0);
    1830              :     }
    1831              : 
    1832          264 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1833              : 
    1834          264 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1835              : 
    1836          264 :     if (tgname && !found)
    1837            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1838              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1839              :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1840              :                         tgname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
    1841              : 
    1842              :     /*
    1843              :      * If we changed anything, broadcast a SI inval message to force each
    1844              :      * backend (including our own!) to rebuild relation's relcache entry.
    1845              :      * Otherwise they will fail to apply the change promptly.
    1846              :      */
    1847          264 :     if (changed)
    1848          260 :         CacheInvalidateRelcache(rel);
    1849          264 : }
    1850              : 
    1851              : 
    1852              : /*
    1853              :  * Build trigger data to attach to the given relcache entry.
    1854              :  *
    1855              :  * Note that trigger data attached to a relcache entry must be stored in
    1856              :  * CacheMemoryContext to ensure it survives as long as the relcache entry.
    1857              :  * But we should be running in a less long-lived working context.  To avoid
    1858              :  * leaking cache memory if this routine fails partway through, we build a
    1859              :  * temporary TriggerDesc in working memory and then copy the completed
    1860              :  * structure into cache memory.
    1861              :  */
    1862              : void
    1863        42312 : RelationBuildTriggers(Relation relation)
    1864              : {
    1865              :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    1866              :     int         numtrigs;
    1867              :     int         maxtrigs;
    1868              :     Trigger    *triggers;
    1869              :     Relation    tgrel;
    1870              :     ScanKeyData skey;
    1871              :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1872              :     HeapTuple   htup;
    1873              :     MemoryContext oldContext;
    1874              :     int         i;
    1875              : 
    1876              :     /*
    1877              :      * Allocate a working array to hold the triggers (the array is extended if
    1878              :      * necessary)
    1879              :      */
    1880        42312 :     maxtrigs = 16;
    1881        42312 :     triggers = (Trigger *) palloc(maxtrigs * sizeof(Trigger));
    1882        42312 :     numtrigs = 0;
    1883              : 
    1884              :     /*
    1885              :      * Note: since we scan the triggers using TriggerRelidNameIndexId, we will
    1886              :      * be reading the triggers in name order, except possibly during
    1887              :      * emergency-recovery operations (ie, IgnoreSystemIndexes). This in turn
    1888              :      * ensures that triggers will be fired in name order.
    1889              :      */
    1890        42312 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey,
    1891              :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1892              :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1893              :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(relation)));
    1894              : 
    1895        42312 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    1896        42312 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1897              :                                 NULL, 1, &skey);
    1898              : 
    1899       118773 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(htup = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1900              :     {
    1901        76461 :         Form_pg_trigger pg_trigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(htup);
    1902              :         Trigger    *build;
    1903              :         Datum       datum;
    1904              :         bool        isnull;
    1905              : 
    1906        76461 :         if (numtrigs >= maxtrigs)
    1907              :         {
    1908           32 :             maxtrigs *= 2;
    1909           32 :             triggers = (Trigger *) repalloc(triggers, maxtrigs * sizeof(Trigger));
    1910              :         }
    1911        76461 :         build = &(triggers[numtrigs]);
    1912              : 
    1913        76461 :         build->tgoid = pg_trigger->oid;
    1914        76461 :         build->tgname = DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout,
    1915              :                                                             NameGetDatum(&pg_trigger->tgname)));
    1916        76461 :         build->tgfoid = pg_trigger->tgfoid;
    1917        76461 :         build->tgtype = pg_trigger->tgtype;
    1918        76461 :         build->tgenabled = pg_trigger->tgenabled;
    1919        76461 :         build->tgisinternal = pg_trigger->tgisinternal;
    1920        76461 :         build->tgisclone = OidIsValid(pg_trigger->tgparentid);
    1921        76461 :         build->tgconstrrelid = pg_trigger->tgconstrrelid;
    1922        76461 :         build->tgconstrindid = pg_trigger->tgconstrindid;
    1923        76461 :         build->tgconstraint = pg_trigger->tgconstraint;
    1924        76461 :         build->tgdeferrable = pg_trigger->tgdeferrable;
    1925        76461 :         build->tginitdeferred = pg_trigger->tginitdeferred;
    1926        76461 :         build->tgnargs = pg_trigger->tgnargs;
    1927              :         /* tgattr is first var-width field, so OK to access directly */
    1928        76461 :         build->tgnattr = pg_trigger->tgattr.dim1;
    1929        76461 :         if (build->tgnattr > 0)
    1930              :         {
    1931          342 :             build->tgattr = (int16 *) palloc(build->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    1932          342 :             memcpy(build->tgattr, &(pg_trigger->tgattr.values),
    1933          342 :                    build->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    1934              :         }
    1935              :         else
    1936        76119 :             build->tgattr = NULL;
    1937        76461 :         if (build->tgnargs > 0)
    1938              :         {
    1939              :             bytea      *val;
    1940              :             char       *p;
    1941              : 
    1942         2788 :             val = DatumGetByteaPP(fastgetattr(htup,
    1943              :                                               Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs,
    1944              :                                               tgrel->rd_att, &isnull));
    1945         2788 :             if (isnull)
    1946            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "tgargs is null in trigger for relation \"%s\"",
    1947              :                      RelationGetRelationName(relation));
    1948         2788 :             p = (char *) VARDATA_ANY(val);
    1949         2788 :             build->tgargs = (char **) palloc(build->tgnargs * sizeof(char *));
    1950         6387 :             for (i = 0; i < build->tgnargs; i++)
    1951              :             {
    1952         3599 :                 build->tgargs[i] = pstrdup(p);
    1953         3599 :                 p += strlen(p) + 1;
    1954              :             }
    1955              :         }
    1956              :         else
    1957        73673 :             build->tgargs = NULL;
    1958              : 
    1959        76461 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable,
    1960              :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1961        76461 :         if (!isnull)
    1962          755 :             build->tgoldtable =
    1963          755 :                 DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout, datum));
    1964              :         else
    1965        75706 :             build->tgoldtable = NULL;
    1966              : 
    1967        76461 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable,
    1968              :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1969        76461 :         if (!isnull)
    1970          992 :             build->tgnewtable =
    1971          992 :                 DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout, datum));
    1972              :         else
    1973        75469 :             build->tgnewtable = NULL;
    1974              : 
    1975        76461 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual,
    1976              :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1977        76461 :         if (!isnull)
    1978          578 :             build->tgqual = TextDatumGetCString(datum);
    1979              :         else
    1980        75883 :             build->tgqual = NULL;
    1981              : 
    1982        76461 :         numtrigs++;
    1983              :     }
    1984              : 
    1985        42312 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1986        42312 :     table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    1987              : 
    1988              :     /* There might not be any triggers */
    1989        42312 :     if (numtrigs == 0)
    1990              :     {
    1991         9838 :         pfree(triggers);
    1992         9838 :         return;
    1993              :     }
    1994              : 
    1995              :     /* Build trigdesc */
    1996        32474 :     trigdesc = palloc0_object(TriggerDesc);
    1997        32474 :     trigdesc->triggers = triggers;
    1998        32474 :     trigdesc->numtriggers = numtrigs;
    1999       108935 :     for (i = 0; i < numtrigs; i++)
    2000        76461 :         SetTriggerFlags(trigdesc, &(triggers[i]));
    2001              : 
    2002              :     /* Copy completed trigdesc into cache storage */
    2003        32474 :     oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CacheMemoryContext);
    2004        32474 :     relation->trigdesc = CopyTriggerDesc(trigdesc);
    2005        32474 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    2006              : 
    2007              :     /* Release working memory */
    2008        32474 :     FreeTriggerDesc(trigdesc);
    2009              : }
    2010              : 
    2011              : /*
    2012              :  * Update the TriggerDesc's hint flags to include the specified trigger
    2013              :  */
    2014              : static void
    2015        76461 : SetTriggerFlags(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Trigger *trigger)
    2016              : {
    2017        76461 :     int16       tgtype = trigger->tgtype;
    2018              : 
    2019        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_before_row |=
    2020        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2021              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2022        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row |=
    2023        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2024              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2025        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_instead_row |=
    2026        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2027              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2028        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_before_statement |=
    2029        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2030              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2031        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_after_statement |=
    2032        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2033              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2034        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_update_before_row |=
    2035        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2036              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2037        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_update_after_row |=
    2038        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2039              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2040        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_update_instead_row |=
    2041        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2042              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2043        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_update_before_statement |=
    2044        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2045              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2046        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_update_after_statement |=
    2047        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2048              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2049        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_before_row |=
    2050        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2051              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2052        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row |=
    2053        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2054              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2055        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_instead_row |=
    2056        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2057              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2058        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_before_statement |=
    2059        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2060              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2061        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_after_statement |=
    2062        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2063              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2064              :     /* there are no row-level truncate triggers */
    2065        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_truncate_before_statement |=
    2066        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2067              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE);
    2068        76461 :     trigdesc->trig_truncate_after_statement |=
    2069        76461 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2070              :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE);
    2071              : 
    2072       152922 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table |=
    2073       101960 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) &&
    2074        25499 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgnewtable));
    2075       152922 :     trigdesc->trig_update_old_table |=
    2076       110914 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) &&
    2077        34453 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgoldtable));
    2078       152922 :     trigdesc->trig_update_new_table |=
    2079       110914 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) &&
    2080        34453 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgnewtable));
    2081       152922 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table |=
    2082        97569 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) &&
    2083        21108 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgoldtable));
    2084        76461 : }
    2085              : 
    2086              : /*
    2087              :  * Copy a TriggerDesc data structure.
    2088              :  *
    2089              :  * The copy is allocated in the current memory context.
    2090              :  */
    2091              : TriggerDesc *
    2092       291797 : CopyTriggerDesc(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2093              : {
    2094              :     TriggerDesc *newdesc;
    2095              :     Trigger    *trigger;
    2096              :     int         i;
    2097              : 
    2098       291797 :     if (trigdesc == NULL || trigdesc->numtriggers <= 0)
    2099       246910 :         return NULL;
    2100              : 
    2101        44887 :     newdesc = palloc_object(TriggerDesc);
    2102        44887 :     memcpy(newdesc, trigdesc, sizeof(TriggerDesc));
    2103              : 
    2104        44887 :     trigger = (Trigger *) palloc(trigdesc->numtriggers * sizeof(Trigger));
    2105        44887 :     memcpy(trigger, trigdesc->triggers,
    2106        44887 :            trigdesc->numtriggers * sizeof(Trigger));
    2107        44887 :     newdesc->triggers = trigger;
    2108              : 
    2109       155410 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2110              :     {
    2111       110523 :         trigger->tgname = pstrdup(trigger->tgname);
    2112       110523 :         if (trigger->tgnattr > 0)
    2113              :         {
    2114              :             int16      *newattr;
    2115              : 
    2116          681 :             newattr = (int16 *) palloc(trigger->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    2117          681 :             memcpy(newattr, trigger->tgattr,
    2118          681 :                    trigger->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    2119          681 :             trigger->tgattr = newattr;
    2120              :         }
    2121       110523 :         if (trigger->tgnargs > 0)
    2122              :         {
    2123              :             char      **newargs;
    2124              :             int16       j;
    2125              : 
    2126         7166 :             newargs = (char **) palloc(trigger->tgnargs * sizeof(char *));
    2127        15739 :             for (j = 0; j < trigger->tgnargs; j++)
    2128         8573 :                 newargs[j] = pstrdup(trigger->tgargs[j]);
    2129         7166 :             trigger->tgargs = newargs;
    2130              :         }
    2131       110523 :         if (trigger->tgqual)
    2132          982 :             trigger->tgqual = pstrdup(trigger->tgqual);
    2133       110523 :         if (trigger->tgoldtable)
    2134         1610 :             trigger->tgoldtable = pstrdup(trigger->tgoldtable);
    2135       110523 :         if (trigger->tgnewtable)
    2136         1883 :             trigger->tgnewtable = pstrdup(trigger->tgnewtable);
    2137       110523 :         trigger++;
    2138              :     }
    2139              : 
    2140        44887 :     return newdesc;
    2141              : }
    2142              : 
    2143              : /*
    2144              :  * Free a TriggerDesc data structure.
    2145              :  */
    2146              : void
    2147       892887 : FreeTriggerDesc(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2148              : {
    2149              :     Trigger    *trigger;
    2150              :     int         i;
    2151              : 
    2152       892887 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2153       830167 :         return;
    2154              : 
    2155        62720 :     trigger = trigdesc->triggers;
    2156       208737 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2157              :     {
    2158       146017 :         pfree(trigger->tgname);
    2159       146017 :         if (trigger->tgnattr > 0)
    2160          647 :             pfree(trigger->tgattr);
    2161       146017 :         if (trigger->tgnargs > 0)
    2162              :         {
    2163        12350 :             while (--(trigger->tgnargs) >= 0)
    2164         6971 :                 pfree(trigger->tgargs[trigger->tgnargs]);
    2165         5379 :             pfree(trigger->tgargs);
    2166              :         }
    2167       146017 :         if (trigger->tgqual)
    2168         1092 :             pfree(trigger->tgqual);
    2169       146017 :         if (trigger->tgoldtable)
    2170         1465 :             pfree(trigger->tgoldtable);
    2171       146017 :         if (trigger->tgnewtable)
    2172         1930 :             pfree(trigger->tgnewtable);
    2173       146017 :         trigger++;
    2174              :     }
    2175        62720 :     pfree(trigdesc->triggers);
    2176        62720 :     pfree(trigdesc);
    2177              : }
    2178              : 
    2179              : /*
    2180              :  * Compare two TriggerDesc structures for logical equality.
    2181              :  */
    2182              : #ifdef NOT_USED
    2183              : bool
    2184              : equalTriggerDescs(TriggerDesc *trigdesc1, TriggerDesc *trigdesc2)
    2185              : {
    2186              :     int         i,
    2187              :                 j;
    2188              : 
    2189              :     /*
    2190              :      * We need not examine the hint flags, just the trigger array itself; if
    2191              :      * we have the same triggers with the same types, the flags should match.
    2192              :      *
    2193              :      * As of 7.3 we assume trigger set ordering is significant in the
    2194              :      * comparison; so we just compare corresponding slots of the two sets.
    2195              :      *
    2196              :      * Note: comparing the stringToNode forms of the WHEN clauses means that
    2197              :      * parse column locations will affect the result.  This is okay as long as
    2198              :      * this function is only used for detecting exact equality, as for example
    2199              :      * in checking for staleness of a cache entry.
    2200              :      */
    2201              :     if (trigdesc1 != NULL)
    2202              :     {
    2203              :         if (trigdesc2 == NULL)
    2204              :             return false;
    2205              :         if (trigdesc1->numtriggers != trigdesc2->numtriggers)
    2206              :             return false;
    2207              :         for (i = 0; i < trigdesc1->numtriggers; i++)
    2208              :         {
    2209              :             Trigger    *trig1 = trigdesc1->triggers + i;
    2210              :             Trigger    *trig2 = trigdesc2->triggers + i;
    2211              : 
    2212              :             if (trig1->tgoid != trig2->tgoid)
    2213              :                 return false;
    2214              :             if (strcmp(trig1->tgname, trig2->tgname) != 0)
    2215              :                 return false;
    2216              :             if (trig1->tgfoid != trig2->tgfoid)
    2217              :                 return false;
    2218              :             if (trig1->tgtype != trig2->tgtype)
    2219              :                 return false;
    2220              :             if (trig1->tgenabled != trig2->tgenabled)
    2221              :                 return false;
    2222              :             if (trig1->tgisinternal != trig2->tgisinternal)
    2223              :                 return false;
    2224              :             if (trig1->tgisclone != trig2->tgisclone)
    2225              :                 return false;
    2226              :             if (trig1->tgconstrrelid != trig2->tgconstrrelid)
    2227              :                 return false;
    2228              :             if (trig1->tgconstrindid != trig2->tgconstrindid)
    2229              :                 return false;
    2230              :             if (trig1->tgconstraint != trig2->tgconstraint)
    2231              :                 return false;
    2232              :             if (trig1->tgdeferrable != trig2->tgdeferrable)
    2233              :                 return false;
    2234              :             if (trig1->tginitdeferred != trig2->tginitdeferred)
    2235              :                 return false;
    2236              :             if (trig1->tgnargs != trig2->tgnargs)
    2237              :                 return false;
    2238              :             if (trig1->tgnattr != trig2->tgnattr)
    2239              :                 return false;
    2240              :             if (trig1->tgnattr > 0 &&
    2241              :                 memcmp(trig1->tgattr, trig2->tgattr,
    2242              :                        trig1->tgnattr * sizeof(int16)) != 0)
    2243              :                 return false;
    2244              :             for (j = 0; j < trig1->tgnargs; j++)
    2245              :                 if (strcmp(trig1->tgargs[j], trig2->tgargs[j]) != 0)
    2246              :                     return false;
    2247              :             if (trig1->tgqual == NULL && trig2->tgqual == NULL)
    2248              :                  /* ok */ ;
    2249              :             else if (trig1->tgqual == NULL || trig2->tgqual == NULL)
    2250              :                 return false;
    2251              :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgqual, trig2->tgqual) != 0)
    2252              :                 return false;
    2253              :             if (trig1->tgoldtable == NULL && trig2->tgoldtable == NULL)
    2254              :                  /* ok */ ;
    2255              :             else if (trig1->tgoldtable == NULL || trig2->tgoldtable == NULL)
    2256              :                 return false;
    2257              :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgoldtable, trig2->tgoldtable) != 0)
    2258              :                 return false;
    2259              :             if (trig1->tgnewtable == NULL && trig2->tgnewtable == NULL)
    2260              :                  /* ok */ ;
    2261              :             else if (trig1->tgnewtable == NULL || trig2->tgnewtable == NULL)
    2262              :                 return false;
    2263              :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgnewtable, trig2->tgnewtable) != 0)
    2264              :                 return false;
    2265              :         }
    2266              :     }
    2267              :     else if (trigdesc2 != NULL)
    2268              :         return false;
    2269              :     return true;
    2270              : }
    2271              : #endif                          /* NOT_USED */
    2272              : 
    2273              : /*
    2274              :  * Check if there is a row-level trigger with transition tables that prevents
    2275              :  * a table from becoming an inheritance child or partition.  Return the name
    2276              :  * of the first such incompatible trigger, or NULL if there is none.
    2277              :  */
    2278              : const char *
    2279         1797 : FindTriggerIncompatibleWithInheritance(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2280              : {
    2281         1797 :     if (trigdesc != NULL)
    2282              :     {
    2283              :         int         i;
    2284              : 
    2285          408 :         for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; ++i)
    2286              :         {
    2287          292 :             Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2288              : 
    2289          292 :             if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(trigger->tgtype))
    2290           24 :                 continue;
    2291          268 :             if (trigger->tgoldtable != NULL || trigger->tgnewtable != NULL)
    2292            8 :                 return trigger->tgname;
    2293              :         }
    2294              :     }
    2295              : 
    2296         1789 :     return NULL;
    2297              : }
    2298              : 
    2299              : /*
    2300              :  * Call a trigger function.
    2301              :  *
    2302              :  *      trigdata: trigger descriptor.
    2303              :  *      tgindx: trigger's index in finfo and instr arrays.
    2304              :  *      finfo: array of cached trigger function call information.
    2305              :  *      instr: optional array of EXPLAIN ANALYZE instrumentation state.
    2306              :  *      per_tuple_context: memory context to execute the function in.
    2307              :  *
    2308              :  * Returns the tuple (or NULL) as returned by the function.
    2309              :  */
    2310              : static HeapTuple
    2311       616425 : ExecCallTriggerFunc(TriggerData *trigdata,
    2312              :                     int tgindx,
    2313              :                     FmgrInfo *finfo,
    2314              :                     TriggerInstrumentation *instr,
    2315              :                     MemoryContext per_tuple_context)
    2316              : {
    2317       616425 :     LOCAL_FCINFO(fcinfo, 0);
    2318              :     PgStat_FunctionCallUsage fcusage;
    2319              :     Datum       result;
    2320              :     MemoryContext oldContext;
    2321              : 
    2322              :     /*
    2323              :      * Protect against code paths that may fail to initialize transition table
    2324              :      * info.
    2325              :      */
    2326              :     Assert(((TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_INSERT(trigdata->tg_event) ||
    2327              :              TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(trigdata->tg_event) ||
    2328              :              TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(trigdata->tg_event)) &&
    2329              :             TRIGGER_FIRED_AFTER(trigdata->tg_event) &&
    2330              :             !(trigdata->tg_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE) &&
    2331              :             !(trigdata->tg_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED)) ||
    2332              :            (trigdata->tg_oldtable == NULL && trigdata->tg_newtable == NULL));
    2333              : 
    2334       616425 :     finfo += tgindx;
    2335              : 
    2336              :     /*
    2337              :      * We cache fmgr lookup info, to avoid making the lookup again on each
    2338              :      * call.
    2339              :      */
    2340       616425 :     if (finfo->fn_oid == InvalidOid)
    2341        12595 :         fmgr_info(trigdata->tg_trigger->tgfoid, finfo);
    2342              : 
    2343              :     Assert(finfo->fn_oid == trigdata->tg_trigger->tgfoid);
    2344              : 
    2345              :     /*
    2346              :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, start charging time to this trigger.
    2347              :      */
    2348       616425 :     if (instr)
    2349            0 :         InstrStartTrigger(instr + tgindx);
    2350              : 
    2351              :     /*
    2352              :      * Do the function evaluation in the per-tuple memory context, so that
    2353              :      * leaked memory will be reclaimed once per tuple. Note in particular that
    2354              :      * any new tuple created by the trigger function will live till the end of
    2355              :      * the tuple cycle.
    2356              :      */
    2357       616425 :     oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(per_tuple_context);
    2358              : 
    2359              :     /*
    2360              :      * Call the function, passing no arguments but setting a context.
    2361              :      */
    2362       616425 :     InitFunctionCallInfoData(*fcinfo, finfo, 0,
    2363              :                              InvalidOid, (Node *) trigdata, NULL);
    2364              : 
    2365       616425 :     pgstat_init_function_usage(fcinfo, &fcusage);
    2366              : 
    2367       616425 :     MyTriggerDepth++;
    2368       616425 :     PG_TRY();
    2369              :     {
    2370       616425 :         result = FunctionCallInvoke(fcinfo);
    2371              :     }
    2372          690 :     PG_FINALLY();
    2373              :     {
    2374       616425 :         MyTriggerDepth--;
    2375              :     }
    2376       616425 :     PG_END_TRY();
    2377              : 
    2378       615735 :     pgstat_end_function_usage(&fcusage, true);
    2379              : 
    2380       615735 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    2381              : 
    2382              :     /*
    2383              :      * Trigger protocol allows function to return a null pointer, but NOT to
    2384              :      * set the isnull result flag.
    2385              :      */
    2386       615735 :     if (fcinfo->isnull)
    2387            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2388              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2389              :                  errmsg("trigger function %u returned null value",
    2390              :                         fcinfo->flinfo->fn_oid)));
    2391              : 
    2392              :     /*
    2393              :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, stop charging time to this trigger, and count
    2394              :      * the firing of the trigger.
    2395              :      */
    2396       615735 :     if (instr)
    2397            0 :         InstrStopTrigger(instr + tgindx, 1);
    2398              : 
    2399       615735 :     return (HeapTuple) DatumGetPointer(result);
    2400              : }
    2401              : 
    2402              : void
    2403        56882 : ExecBSInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2404              : {
    2405              :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2406              :     int         i;
    2407        56882 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2408              : 
    2409        56882 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2410              : 
    2411        56882 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2412        56711 :         return;
    2413         5052 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_insert_before_statement)
    2414         4881 :         return;
    2415              : 
    2416              :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2417          171 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2418              :                                    CMD_INSERT))
    2419            0 :         return;
    2420              : 
    2421          171 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2422          171 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2423              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2424          171 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2425         1501 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2426              :     {
    2427         1338 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2428              :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2429              : 
    2430         1338 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2431              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2432              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2433              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2434         1159 :             continue;
    2435          179 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2436              :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    2437           20 :             continue;
    2438              : 
    2439          159 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2440          159 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2441              :                                        i,
    2442              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2443              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2444          159 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2445              : 
    2446          151 :         if (newtuple)
    2447            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2448              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2449              :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2450              :     }
    2451              : }
    2452              : 
    2453              : void
    2454        55083 : ExecASInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2455              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2456              : {
    2457        55083 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2458              : 
    2459        55083 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_insert_after_statement)
    2460          349 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2461              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT,
    2462              :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, transition_capture,
    2463              :                               false);
    2464        55083 : }
    2465              : 
    2466              : bool
    2467         1610 : ExecBRInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2468              :                      TupleTableSlot *slot)
    2469              : {
    2470         1610 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2471         1610 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2472              :     bool        should_free;
    2473         1610 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2474              :     int         i;
    2475              : 
    2476         1610 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2477         1610 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2478              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2479              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2480         1610 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2481         7566 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2482              :     {
    2483         6160 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2484              :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    2485              : 
    2486         6160 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2487              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2488              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2489              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2490         3024 :             continue;
    2491         3136 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2492              :                             NULL, NULL, slot))
    2493           41 :             continue;
    2494              : 
    2495         3095 :         if (!newtuple)
    2496         1587 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2497              : 
    2498         3095 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2499         3095 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    2500         3095 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2501         3095 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2502              :                                        i,
    2503              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2504              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2505         3095 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2506         3049 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2507              :         {
    2508          142 :             if (should_free)
    2509           13 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2510          142 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    2511              :         }
    2512         2907 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    2513              :         {
    2514          532 :             newtuple = check_modified_virtual_generated(RelationGetDescr(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc), newtuple);
    2515              : 
    2516          532 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, slot, false);
    2517              : 
    2518              :             /*
    2519              :              * After a tuple in a partition goes through a trigger, the user
    2520              :              * could have changed the partition key enough that the tuple no
    2521              :              * longer fits the partition.  Verify that.
    2522              :              */
    2523          532 :             if (trigger->tgisclone &&
    2524           44 :                 !ExecPartitionCheck(relinfo, slot, estate, false))
    2525           16 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    2526              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    2527              :                          errmsg("moving row to another partition during a BEFORE FOR EACH ROW trigger is not supported"),
    2528              :                          errdetail("Before executing trigger \"%s\", the row was to be in partition \"%s.%s\".",
    2529              :                                    trigger->tgname,
    2530              :                                    get_namespace_name(RelationGetNamespace(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc)),
    2531              :                                    RelationGetRelationName(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc))));
    2532              : 
    2533          516 :             if (should_free)
    2534           26 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2535              : 
    2536              :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    2537          516 :             newtuple = NULL;
    2538              :         }
    2539              :     }
    2540              : 
    2541         1406 :     return true;
    2542              : }
    2543              : 
    2544              : void
    2545      7979103 : ExecARInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2546              :                      TupleTableSlot *slot, List *recheckIndexes,
    2547              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2548              : {
    2549      7979103 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2550              : 
    2551      7979103 :     if (relinfo->ri_FdwRoutine && transition_capture &&
    2552            4 :         transition_capture->tcs_insert_new_table)
    2553              :     {
    2554              :         Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo);
    2555            4 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2556              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    2557              :                  errmsg("cannot collect transition tuples from child foreign tables")));
    2558              :     }
    2559              : 
    2560      7979099 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row) ||
    2561        40224 :         (transition_capture && transition_capture->tcs_insert_new_table))
    2562       445548 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2563              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT,
    2564              :                               true, NULL, slot,
    2565              :                               recheckIndexes, NULL,
    2566              :                               transition_capture,
    2567              :                               false);
    2568      7979099 : }
    2569              : 
    2570              : bool
    2571          119 : ExecIRInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2572              :                      TupleTableSlot *slot)
    2573              : {
    2574          119 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2575          119 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2576              :     bool        should_free;
    2577          119 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2578              :     int         i;
    2579              : 
    2580          119 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2581          119 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2582              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2583              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    2584          119 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2585          362 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2586              :     {
    2587          255 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2588              :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    2589              : 
    2590          255 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2591              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2592              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    2593              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2594          136 :             continue;
    2595          119 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2596              :                             NULL, NULL, slot))
    2597            0 :             continue;
    2598              : 
    2599          119 :         if (!newtuple)
    2600          119 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2601              : 
    2602          119 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2603          119 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    2604          119 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2605          119 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2606              :                                        i,
    2607              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2608              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2609          119 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2610          119 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2611              :         {
    2612           12 :             if (should_free)
    2613           12 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2614           12 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    2615              :         }
    2616          107 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    2617              :         {
    2618           36 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, slot, false);
    2619              : 
    2620           36 :             if (should_free)
    2621           36 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2622              : 
    2623              :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    2624           36 :             newtuple = NULL;
    2625              :         }
    2626              :     }
    2627              : 
    2628          107 :     return true;
    2629              : }
    2630              : 
    2631              : void
    2632         8567 : ExecBSDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2633              : {
    2634              :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2635              :     int         i;
    2636         8567 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2637              : 
    2638         8567 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2639              : 
    2640         8567 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2641         8508 :         return;
    2642         1066 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_delete_before_statement)
    2643          979 :         return;
    2644              : 
    2645              :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2646           87 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2647              :                                    CMD_DELETE))
    2648           28 :         return;
    2649              : 
    2650           59 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2651           59 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2652              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2653           59 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2654          540 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2655              :     {
    2656          481 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2657              :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2658              : 
    2659          481 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2660              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2661              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2662              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2663          422 :             continue;
    2664           59 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2665              :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    2666            8 :             continue;
    2667              : 
    2668           51 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2669           51 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2670              :                                        i,
    2671              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2672              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2673           51 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2674              : 
    2675           51 :         if (newtuple)
    2676            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2677              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2678              :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2679              :     }
    2680              : }
    2681              : 
    2682              : void
    2683         8444 : ExecASDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2684              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2685              : {
    2686         8444 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2687              : 
    2688         8444 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_delete_after_statement)
    2689          165 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2690              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE,
    2691              :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, transition_capture,
    2692              :                               false);
    2693         8444 : }
    2694              : 
    2695              : /*
    2696              :  * Execute BEFORE ROW DELETE triggers.
    2697              :  *
    2698              :  * True indicates caller can proceed with the delete.  False indicates caller
    2699              :  * need to suppress the delete and additionally if requested, we need to pass
    2700              :  * back the concurrently updated tuple if any.
    2701              :  */
    2702              : bool
    2703          217 : ExecBRDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, EPQState *epqstate,
    2704              :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2705              :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2706              :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2707              :                      TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
    2708              :                      TM_Result *tmresult,
    2709              :                      TM_FailureData *tmfd,
    2710              :                      bool is_merge_delete)
    2711              : {
    2712          217 :     TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2713          217 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2714          217 :     bool        result = true;
    2715          217 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2716              :     HeapTuple   trigtuple;
    2717          217 :     bool        should_free = false;
    2718              :     int         i;
    2719              : 
    2720              :     Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2721          217 :     if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2722              :     {
    2723          209 :         TupleTableSlot *epqslot_candidate = NULL;
    2724              : 
    2725              :         /*
    2726              :          * Get a copy of the on-disk tuple we are planning to delete.  In
    2727              :          * general, if the tuple has been concurrently updated, we should
    2728              :          * recheck it using EPQ.  However, if this is a MERGE DELETE action,
    2729              :          * we skip this EPQ recheck and leave it to the caller (it must do
    2730              :          * additional rechecking, and might end up executing a different
    2731              :          * action entirely).
    2732              :          */
    2733          205 :         if (!GetTupleForTrigger(estate, epqstate, relinfo, tupleid,
    2734              :                                 LockTupleExclusive, slot, !is_merge_delete,
    2735          209 :                                 &epqslot_candidate, tmresult, tmfd))
    2736            6 :             return false;
    2737              : 
    2738              :         /*
    2739              :          * If the tuple was concurrently updated and the caller of this
    2740              :          * function requested for the updated tuple, skip the trigger
    2741              :          * execution.
    2742              :          */
    2743          200 :         if (epqslot_candidate != NULL && epqslot != NULL)
    2744              :         {
    2745            1 :             *epqslot = epqslot_candidate;
    2746            1 :             return false;
    2747              :         }
    2748              : 
    2749          199 :         trigtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2750              :     }
    2751              :     else
    2752              :     {
    2753            8 :         trigtuple = fdw_trigtuple;
    2754            8 :         ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, slot, false);
    2755              :     }
    2756              : 
    2757          207 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2758          207 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2759              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2760              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2761          207 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2762          832 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2763              :     {
    2764              :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2765          665 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2766              : 
    2767          665 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2768              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2769              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2770              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2771          454 :             continue;
    2772          211 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2773              :                             NULL, slot, NULL))
    2774            9 :             continue;
    2775              : 
    2776          202 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2777          202 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    2778          202 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2779          202 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2780              :                                        i,
    2781              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2782              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2783          202 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2784          196 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2785              :         {
    2786           34 :             result = false;     /* tell caller to suppress delete */
    2787           34 :             break;
    2788              :         }
    2789          162 :         if (newtuple != trigtuple)
    2790           33 :             heap_freetuple(newtuple);
    2791              :     }
    2792          201 :     if (should_free)
    2793            0 :         heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    2794              : 
    2795          201 :     return result;
    2796              : }
    2797              : 
    2798              : /*
    2799              :  * Note: is_crosspart_update must be true if the DELETE is being performed
    2800              :  * as part of a cross-partition update.
    2801              :  */
    2802              : void
    2803      1071768 : ExecARDeleteTriggers(EState *estate,
    2804              :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2805              :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2806              :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2807              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    2808              :                      bool is_crosspart_update)
    2809              : {
    2810      1071768 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2811              : 
    2812      1071768 :     if (relinfo->ri_FdwRoutine && transition_capture &&
    2813            2 :         transition_capture->tcs_delete_old_table)
    2814              :     {
    2815              :         Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo);
    2816            2 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2817              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    2818              :                  errmsg("cannot collect transition tuples from child foreign tables")));
    2819              :     }
    2820              : 
    2821      1071766 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row) ||
    2822         3344 :         (transition_capture && transition_capture->tcs_delete_old_table))
    2823              :     {
    2824         4150 :         TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2825              : 
    2826              :         Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2827         4150 :         if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2828         4142 :             GetTupleForTrigger(estate,
    2829              :                                NULL,
    2830              :                                relinfo,
    2831              :                                tupleid,
    2832              :                                LockTupleExclusive,
    2833              :                                slot,
    2834              :                                false,
    2835              :                                NULL,
    2836              :                                NULL,
    2837              :                                NULL);
    2838              :         else
    2839            8 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, slot, false);
    2840              : 
    2841         4150 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2842              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE,
    2843              :                               true, slot, NULL, NIL, NULL,
    2844              :                               transition_capture,
    2845              :                               is_crosspart_update);
    2846              :     }
    2847      1071766 : }
    2848              : 
    2849              : bool
    2850           39 : ExecIRDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2851              :                      HeapTuple trigtuple)
    2852              : {
    2853           39 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2854           39 :     TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2855           39 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2856              :     int         i;
    2857              : 
    2858           39 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2859           39 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2860              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2861              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    2862           39 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2863              : 
    2864           39 :     ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, slot, false);
    2865              : 
    2866          234 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2867              :     {
    2868              :         HeapTuple   rettuple;
    2869          199 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2870              : 
    2871          199 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2872              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2873              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    2874              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2875          160 :             continue;
    2876           39 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2877              :                             NULL, slot, NULL))
    2878            0 :             continue;
    2879              : 
    2880           39 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2881           39 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    2882           39 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2883           39 :         rettuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2884              :                                        i,
    2885              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2886              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2887           39 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2888           39 :         if (rettuple == NULL)
    2889            4 :             return false;       /* Delete was suppressed */
    2890           35 :         if (rettuple != trigtuple)
    2891            0 :             heap_freetuple(rettuple);
    2892              :     }
    2893           35 :     return true;
    2894              : }
    2895              : 
    2896              : void
    2897        10147 : ExecBSUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2898              : {
    2899              :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2900              :     int         i;
    2901        10147 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2902              :     Bitmapset  *updatedCols;
    2903              : 
    2904        10147 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2905              : 
    2906        10147 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2907        10018 :         return;
    2908         2743 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_update_before_statement)
    2909         2614 :         return;
    2910              : 
    2911              :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2912          129 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2913              :                                    CMD_UPDATE))
    2914            0 :         return;
    2915              : 
    2916              :     /* statement-level triggers operate on the parent table */
    2917              :     Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo == NULL);
    2918              : 
    2919          129 :     updatedCols = ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate);
    2920              : 
    2921          129 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2922          129 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    2923              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2924          129 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2925          129 :     LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = updatedCols;
    2926         1168 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2927              :     {
    2928         1039 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2929              :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2930              : 
    2931         1039 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2932              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2933              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2934              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    2935          910 :             continue;
    2936          129 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2937              :                             updatedCols, NULL, NULL))
    2938            4 :             continue;
    2939              : 
    2940          125 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2941          125 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2942              :                                        i,
    2943              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2944              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2945          125 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2946              : 
    2947          125 :         if (newtuple)
    2948            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2949              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2950              :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2951              :     }
    2952              : }
    2953              : 
    2954              : void
    2955         9505 : ExecASUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2956              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2957              : {
    2958         9505 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2959              : 
    2960              :     /* statement-level triggers operate on the parent table */
    2961              :     Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo == NULL);
    2962              : 
    2963         9505 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_update_after_statement)
    2964          277 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2965              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE,
    2966              :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL,
    2967              :                               ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate),
    2968              :                               transition_capture,
    2969              :                               false);
    2970         9505 : }
    2971              : 
    2972              : bool
    2973         1572 : ExecBRUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, EPQState *epqstate,
    2974              :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2975              :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2976              :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2977              :                      TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    2978              :                      TM_Result *tmresult,
    2979              :                      TM_FailureData *tmfd,
    2980              :                      bool is_merge_update)
    2981              : {
    2982         1572 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2983         1572 :     TupleTableSlot *oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2984         1572 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2985              :     HeapTuple   trigtuple;
    2986         1572 :     bool        should_free_trig = false;
    2987         1572 :     bool        should_free_new = false;
    2988         1572 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2989              :     int         i;
    2990              :     Bitmapset  *updatedCols;
    2991              :     LockTupleMode lockmode;
    2992              : 
    2993              :     /* Determine lock mode to use */
    2994         1572 :     lockmode = ExecUpdateLockMode(estate, relinfo);
    2995              : 
    2996              :     Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2997         1572 :     if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2998              :     {
    2999         1553 :         TupleTableSlot *epqslot_candidate = NULL;
    3000              : 
    3001              :         /*
    3002              :          * Get a copy of the on-disk tuple we are planning to update.  In
    3003              :          * general, if the tuple has been concurrently updated, we should
    3004              :          * recheck it using EPQ.  However, if this is a MERGE UPDATE action,
    3005              :          * we skip this EPQ recheck and leave it to the caller (it must do
    3006              :          * additional rechecking, and might end up executing a different
    3007              :          * action entirely).
    3008              :          */
    3009         1549 :         if (!GetTupleForTrigger(estate, epqstate, relinfo, tupleid,
    3010              :                                 lockmode, oldslot, !is_merge_update,
    3011         1553 :                                 &epqslot_candidate, tmresult, tmfd))
    3012           12 :             return false;       /* cancel the update action */
    3013              : 
    3014              :         /*
    3015              :          * In READ COMMITTED isolation level it's possible that target tuple
    3016              :          * was changed due to concurrent update.  In that case we have a raw
    3017              :          * subplan output tuple in epqslot_candidate, and need to form a new
    3018              :          * insertable tuple using ExecGetUpdateNewTuple to replace the one we
    3019              :          * received in newslot.  Neither we nor our callers have any further
    3020              :          * interest in the passed-in tuple, so it's okay to overwrite newslot
    3021              :          * with the newer data.
    3022              :          */
    3023         1537 :         if (epqslot_candidate != NULL)
    3024              :         {
    3025              :             TupleTableSlot *epqslot_clean;
    3026              : 
    3027            3 :             epqslot_clean = ExecGetUpdateNewTuple(relinfo, epqslot_candidate,
    3028              :                                                   oldslot);
    3029              : 
    3030              :             /*
    3031              :              * Typically, the caller's newslot was also generated by
    3032              :              * ExecGetUpdateNewTuple, so that epqslot_clean will be the same
    3033              :              * slot and copying is not needed.  But do the right thing if it
    3034              :              * isn't.
    3035              :              */
    3036            3 :             if (unlikely(newslot != epqslot_clean))
    3037            0 :                 ExecCopySlot(newslot, epqslot_clean);
    3038              : 
    3039              :             /*
    3040              :              * At this point newslot contains a virtual tuple that may
    3041              :              * reference some fields of oldslot's tuple in some disk buffer.
    3042              :              * If that tuple is in a different page than the original target
    3043              :              * tuple, then our only pin on that buffer is oldslot's, and we're
    3044              :              * about to release it.  Hence we'd better materialize newslot to
    3045              :              * ensure it doesn't contain references into an unpinned buffer.
    3046              :              * (We'd materialize it below anyway, but too late for safety.)
    3047              :              */
    3048            3 :             ExecMaterializeSlot(newslot);
    3049              :         }
    3050              : 
    3051              :         /*
    3052              :          * Here we convert oldslot to a materialized slot holding trigtuple.
    3053              :          * Neither slot passed to the triggers will hold any buffer pin.
    3054              :          */
    3055         1537 :         trigtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(oldslot, true, &should_free_trig);
    3056              :     }
    3057              :     else
    3058              :     {
    3059              :         /* Put the FDW-supplied tuple into oldslot to unify the cases */
    3060           19 :         ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3061           19 :         trigtuple = fdw_trigtuple;
    3062              :     }
    3063              : 
    3064         1556 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3065         1556 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    3066              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    3067              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    3068         1556 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3069         1556 :     updatedCols = ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate);
    3070         1556 :     LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = updatedCols;
    3071         7408 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3072              :     {
    3073         5946 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3074              :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    3075              : 
    3076         5946 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3077              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    3078              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    3079              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    3080         3018 :             continue;
    3081         2928 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3082              :                             updatedCols, oldslot, newslot))
    3083           65 :             continue;
    3084              : 
    3085         2863 :         if (!newtuple)
    3086         1547 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(newslot, true, &should_free_new);
    3087              : 
    3088         2863 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = oldslot;
    3089         2863 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    3090         2863 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    3091         2863 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = newslot;
    3092         2863 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3093         2863 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3094              :                                        i,
    3095              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3096              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3097         2863 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3098              : 
    3099         2855 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    3100              :         {
    3101           86 :             if (should_free_trig)
    3102            0 :                 heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    3103           86 :             if (should_free_new)
    3104            2 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3105           86 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    3106              :         }
    3107         2769 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    3108              :         {
    3109          736 :             newtuple = check_modified_virtual_generated(RelationGetDescr(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc), newtuple);
    3110              : 
    3111          736 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, newslot, false);
    3112              : 
    3113              :             /*
    3114              :              * If the tuple returned by the trigger / being stored, is the old
    3115              :              * row version, and the heap tuple passed to the trigger was
    3116              :              * allocated locally, materialize the slot. Otherwise we might
    3117              :              * free it while still referenced by the slot.
    3118              :              */
    3119          736 :             if (should_free_trig && newtuple == trigtuple)
    3120            0 :                 ExecMaterializeSlot(newslot);
    3121              : 
    3122          736 :             if (should_free_new)
    3123            1 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3124              : 
    3125              :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    3126          736 :             newtuple = NULL;
    3127              :         }
    3128              :     }
    3129         1462 :     if (should_free_trig)
    3130            0 :         heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    3131              : 
    3132         1462 :     return true;
    3133              : }
    3134              : 
    3135              : /*
    3136              :  * Note: 'src_partinfo' and 'dst_partinfo', when non-NULL, refer to the source
    3137              :  * and destination partitions, respectively, of a cross-partition update of
    3138              :  * the root partitioned table mentioned in the query, given by 'relinfo'.
    3139              :  * 'tupleid' in that case refers to the ctid of the "old" tuple in the source
    3140              :  * partition, and 'newslot' contains the "new" tuple in the destination
    3141              :  * partition.  This interface allows to support the requirements of
    3142              :  * ExecCrossPartitionUpdateForeignKey(); is_crosspart_update must be true in
    3143              :  * that case.
    3144              :  */
    3145              : void
    3146      2256485 : ExecARUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3147              :                      ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
    3148              :                      ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
    3149              :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    3150              :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    3151              :                      TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    3152              :                      List *recheckIndexes,
    3153              :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    3154              :                      bool is_crosspart_update)
    3155              : {
    3156      2256485 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3157              : 
    3158      2256485 :     if (relinfo->ri_FdwRoutine && transition_capture &&
    3159            2 :         (transition_capture->tcs_update_old_table ||
    3160            0 :          transition_capture->tcs_update_new_table))
    3161              :     {
    3162              :         Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo);
    3163            2 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3164              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    3165              :                  errmsg("cannot collect transition tuples from child foreign tables")));
    3166              :     }
    3167              : 
    3168      2256483 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_update_after_row) ||
    3169          247 :         (transition_capture &&
    3170          247 :          (transition_capture->tcs_update_old_table ||
    3171           12 :           transition_capture->tcs_update_new_table)))
    3172              :     {
    3173              :         /*
    3174              :          * Note: if the UPDATE is converted into a DELETE+INSERT as part of
    3175              :          * update-partition-key operation, then this function is also called
    3176              :          * separately for DELETE and INSERT to capture transition table rows.
    3177              :          * In such case, either old tuple or new tuple can be NULL.
    3178              :          */
    3179              :         TupleTableSlot *oldslot;
    3180              :         ResultRelInfo *tupsrc;
    3181              : 
    3182              :         Assert((src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL) ||
    3183              :                !is_crosspart_update);
    3184              : 
    3185         2444 :         tupsrc = src_partinfo ? src_partinfo : relinfo;
    3186         2444 :         oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, tupsrc);
    3187              : 
    3188         2444 :         if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL && ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid))
    3189         2402 :             GetTupleForTrigger(estate,
    3190              :                                NULL,
    3191              :                                tupsrc,
    3192              :                                tupleid,
    3193              :                                LockTupleExclusive,
    3194              :                                oldslot,
    3195              :                                false,
    3196              :                                NULL,
    3197              :                                NULL,
    3198              :                                NULL);
    3199           42 :         else if (fdw_trigtuple != NULL)
    3200           10 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3201              :         else
    3202           32 :             ExecClearTuple(oldslot);
    3203              : 
    3204         2444 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo,
    3205              :                               src_partinfo, dst_partinfo,
    3206              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE,
    3207              :                               true,
    3208              :                               oldslot, newslot, recheckIndexes,
    3209              :                               ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate),
    3210              :                               transition_capture,
    3211              :                               is_crosspart_update);
    3212              :     }
    3213      2256483 : }
    3214              : 
    3215              : bool
    3216          135 : ExecIRUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3217              :                      HeapTuple trigtuple, TupleTableSlot *newslot)
    3218              : {
    3219          135 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3220          135 :     TupleTableSlot *oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    3221          135 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    3222              :     bool        should_free;
    3223          135 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    3224              :     int         i;
    3225              : 
    3226          135 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3227          135 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    3228              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    3229              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    3230          135 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3231              : 
    3232          135 :     ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3233              : 
    3234          502 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3235              :     {
    3236          387 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3237              :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    3238              : 
    3239          387 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3240              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    3241              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    3242              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    3243          252 :             continue;
    3244          135 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3245              :                             NULL, oldslot, newslot))
    3246            0 :             continue;
    3247              : 
    3248          135 :         if (!newtuple)
    3249          135 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(newslot, true, &should_free);
    3250              : 
    3251          135 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = oldslot;
    3252          135 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    3253          135 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = newslot;
    3254          135 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    3255              : 
    3256          135 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3257          135 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3258              :                                        i,
    3259              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3260              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3261          135 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3262          127 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    3263              :         {
    3264           12 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    3265              :         }
    3266          115 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    3267              :         {
    3268           92 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, newslot, false);
    3269              : 
    3270           92 :             if (should_free)
    3271           92 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3272              : 
    3273              :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    3274           92 :             newtuple = NULL;
    3275              :         }
    3276              :     }
    3277              : 
    3278          115 :     return true;
    3279              : }
    3280              : 
    3281              : void
    3282         2518 : ExecBSTruncateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    3283              : {
    3284              :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    3285              :     int         i;
    3286         2518 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    3287              : 
    3288         2518 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3289              : 
    3290         2518 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    3291         2511 :         return;
    3292          491 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_truncate_before_statement)
    3293          484 :         return;
    3294              : 
    3295            7 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3296            7 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE |
    3297              :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    3298            7 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3299              : 
    3300           20 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3301              :     {
    3302           13 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3303              :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    3304              : 
    3305           13 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3306              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    3307              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    3308              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE))
    3309            6 :             continue;
    3310            7 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3311              :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    3312            0 :             continue;
    3313              : 
    3314            7 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3315            7 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3316              :                                        i,
    3317              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3318              :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3319            7 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3320              : 
    3321            7 :         if (newtuple)
    3322            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3323              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    3324              :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    3325              :     }
    3326              : }
    3327              : 
    3328              : void
    3329         2514 : ExecASTruncateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    3330              : {
    3331         2514 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3332              : 
    3333         2514 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_truncate_after_statement)
    3334            5 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo,
    3335              :                               NULL, NULL,
    3336              :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE,
    3337              :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, NULL,
    3338              :                               false);
    3339         2514 : }
    3340              : 
    3341              : 
    3342              : /*
    3343              :  * Fetch tuple into "oldslot", dealing with locking and EPQ if necessary
    3344              :  */
    3345              : static bool
    3346         8306 : GetTupleForTrigger(EState *estate,
    3347              :                    EPQState *epqstate,
    3348              :                    ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3349              :                    ItemPointer tid,
    3350              :                    LockTupleMode lockmode,
    3351              :                    TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    3352              :                    bool do_epq_recheck,
    3353              :                    TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
    3354              :                    TM_Result *tmresultp,
    3355              :                    TM_FailureData *tmfdp)
    3356              : {
    3357         8306 :     Relation    relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3358              : 
    3359         8306 :     if (epqslot != NULL)
    3360              :     {
    3361              :         TM_Result   test;
    3362              :         TM_FailureData tmfd;
    3363         1762 :         int         lockflags = 0;
    3364              : 
    3365         1762 :         *epqslot = NULL;
    3366              : 
    3367              :         /* caller must pass an epqstate if EvalPlanQual is possible */
    3368              :         Assert(epqstate != NULL);
    3369              : 
    3370              :         /*
    3371              :          * lock tuple for update
    3372              :          */
    3373         1762 :         if (!IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3374         1329 :             lockflags |= TUPLE_LOCK_FLAG_FIND_LAST_VERSION;
    3375         1762 :         test = table_tuple_lock(relation, tid, estate->es_snapshot, oldslot,
    3376              :                                 estate->es_output_cid,
    3377              :                                 lockmode, LockWaitBlock,
    3378              :                                 lockflags,
    3379              :                                 &tmfd);
    3380              : 
    3381              :         /* Let the caller know about the status of this operation */
    3382         1760 :         if (tmresultp)
    3383          148 :             *tmresultp = test;
    3384         1760 :         if (tmfdp)
    3385         1757 :             *tmfdp = tmfd;
    3386              : 
    3387         1760 :         switch (test)
    3388              :         {
    3389            4 :             case TM_SelfModified:
    3390              : 
    3391              :                 /*
    3392              :                  * The target tuple was already updated or deleted by the
    3393              :                  * current command, or by a later command in the current
    3394              :                  * transaction.  We ignore the tuple in the former case, and
    3395              :                  * throw error in the latter case, for the same reasons
    3396              :                  * enumerated in ExecUpdate and ExecDelete in
    3397              :                  * nodeModifyTable.c.
    3398              :                  */
    3399            4 :                 if (tmfd.cmax != estate->es_output_cid)
    3400            4 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3401              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_TRIGGERED_DATA_CHANGE_VIOLATION),
    3402              :                              errmsg("tuple to be updated was already modified by an operation triggered by the current command"),
    3403              :                              errhint("Consider using an AFTER trigger instead of a BEFORE trigger to propagate changes to other rows.")));
    3404              : 
    3405              :                 /* treat it as deleted; do not process */
    3406           17 :                 return false;
    3407              : 
    3408         1747 :             case TM_Ok:
    3409         1747 :                 if (tmfd.traversed)
    3410              :                 {
    3411              :                     /*
    3412              :                      * Recheck the tuple using EPQ, if requested.  Otherwise,
    3413              :                      * just return that it was concurrently updated.
    3414              :                      */
    3415           14 :                     if (do_epq_recheck)
    3416              :                     {
    3417            6 :                         *epqslot = EvalPlanQual(epqstate,
    3418              :                                                 relation,
    3419              :                                                 relinfo->ri_RangeTableIndex,
    3420              :                                                 oldslot);
    3421              : 
    3422              :                         /*
    3423              :                          * If PlanQual failed for updated tuple - we must not
    3424              :                          * process this tuple!
    3425              :                          */
    3426            6 :                         if (TupIsNull(*epqslot))
    3427              :                         {
    3428            2 :                             *epqslot = NULL;
    3429            2 :                             return false;
    3430              :                         }
    3431              :                     }
    3432              :                     else
    3433              :                     {
    3434            8 :                         if (tmresultp)
    3435            8 :                             *tmresultp = TM_Updated;
    3436            8 :                         return false;
    3437              :                     }
    3438              :                 }
    3439         1737 :                 break;
    3440              : 
    3441            1 :             case TM_Updated:
    3442            1 :                 if (IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3443            1 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3444              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_T_R_SERIALIZATION_FAILURE),
    3445              :                              errmsg("could not serialize access due to concurrent update")));
    3446            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unexpected table_tuple_lock status: %u", test);
    3447              :                 break;
    3448              : 
    3449            8 :             case TM_Deleted:
    3450            8 :                 if (IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3451            1 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3452              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_T_R_SERIALIZATION_FAILURE),
    3453              :                              errmsg("could not serialize access due to concurrent delete")));
    3454              :                 /* tuple was deleted */
    3455            7 :                 return false;
    3456              : 
    3457            0 :             case TM_Invisible:
    3458            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "attempted to lock invisible tuple");
    3459              :                 break;
    3460              : 
    3461            0 :             default:
    3462            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized table_tuple_lock status: %u", test);
    3463              :                 return false;   /* keep compiler quiet */
    3464              :         }
    3465              :     }
    3466              :     else
    3467              :     {
    3468              :         /*
    3469              :          * We expect the tuple to be present, thus very simple error handling
    3470              :          * suffices.
    3471              :          */
    3472         6544 :         if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(relation, tid, SnapshotAny,
    3473              :                                            oldslot))
    3474            0 :             elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple for trigger");
    3475              :     }
    3476              : 
    3477         8281 :     return true;
    3478              : }
    3479              : 
    3480              : /*
    3481              :  * Is trigger enabled to fire?
    3482              :  */
    3483              : static bool
    3484       618045 : TriggerEnabled(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3485              :                Trigger *trigger, TriggerEvent event,
    3486              :                Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
    3487              :                TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot)
    3488              : {
    3489              :     /* Check replication-role-dependent enable state */
    3490       618045 :     if (SessionReplicationRole == SESSION_REPLICATION_ROLE_REPLICA)
    3491              :     {
    3492           72 :         if (trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_ORIGIN ||
    3493           47 :             trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_DISABLED)
    3494           49 :             return false;
    3495              :     }
    3496              :     else                        /* ORIGIN or LOCAL role */
    3497              :     {
    3498       617973 :         if (trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_REPLICA ||
    3499       617972 :             trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_DISABLED)
    3500          105 :             return false;
    3501              :     }
    3502              : 
    3503              :     /*
    3504              :      * Check for column-specific trigger (only possible for UPDATE, and in
    3505              :      * fact we *must* ignore tgattr for other event types)
    3506              :      */
    3507       617891 :     if (trigger->tgnattr > 0 && TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event))
    3508              :     {
    3509              :         int         i;
    3510              :         bool        modified;
    3511              : 
    3512          286 :         modified = false;
    3513          374 :         for (i = 0; i < trigger->tgnattr; i++)
    3514              :         {
    3515          318 :             if (bms_is_member(trigger->tgattr[i] - FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber,
    3516              :                               modifiedCols))
    3517              :             {
    3518          230 :                 modified = true;
    3519          230 :                 break;
    3520              :             }
    3521              :         }
    3522          286 :         if (!modified)
    3523           56 :             return false;
    3524              :     }
    3525              : 
    3526              :     /* Check for WHEN clause */
    3527       617835 :     if (trigger->tgqual)
    3528              :     {
    3529              :         ExprState **predicate;
    3530              :         ExprContext *econtext;
    3531              :         MemoryContext oldContext;
    3532              :         int         i;
    3533              : 
    3534              :         Assert(estate != NULL);
    3535              : 
    3536              :         /*
    3537              :          * trigger is an element of relinfo->ri_TrigDesc->triggers[]; find the
    3538              :          * matching element of relinfo->ri_TrigWhenExprs[]
    3539              :          */
    3540          376 :         i = trigger - relinfo->ri_TrigDesc->triggers;
    3541          376 :         predicate = &relinfo->ri_TrigWhenExprs[i];
    3542              : 
    3543              :         /*
    3544              :          * If first time through for this WHEN expression, build expression
    3545              :          * nodetrees for it.  Keep them in the per-query memory context so
    3546              :          * they'll survive throughout the query.
    3547              :          */
    3548          376 :         if (*predicate == NULL)
    3549              :         {
    3550              :             Node       *tgqual;
    3551              : 
    3552          198 :             oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(estate->es_query_cxt);
    3553          198 :             tgqual = stringToNode(trigger->tgqual);
    3554          198 :             tgqual = expand_generated_columns_in_expr(tgqual, relinfo->ri_RelationDesc, PRS2_OLD_VARNO);
    3555          198 :             tgqual = expand_generated_columns_in_expr(tgqual, relinfo->ri_RelationDesc, PRS2_NEW_VARNO);
    3556              :             /* Change references to OLD and NEW to INNER_VAR and OUTER_VAR */
    3557          198 :             ChangeVarNodes(tgqual, PRS2_OLD_VARNO, INNER_VAR, 0);
    3558          198 :             ChangeVarNodes(tgqual, PRS2_NEW_VARNO, OUTER_VAR, 0);
    3559              :             /* ExecPrepareQual wants implicit-AND form */
    3560          198 :             tgqual = (Node *) make_ands_implicit((Expr *) tgqual);
    3561          198 :             *predicate = ExecPrepareQual((List *) tgqual, estate);
    3562          198 :             MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    3563              :         }
    3564              : 
    3565              :         /*
    3566              :          * We will use the EState's per-tuple context for evaluating WHEN
    3567              :          * expressions (creating it if it's not already there).
    3568              :          */
    3569          376 :         econtext = GetPerTupleExprContext(estate);
    3570              : 
    3571              :         /*
    3572              :          * Finally evaluate the expression, making the old and/or new tuples
    3573              :          * available as INNER_VAR/OUTER_VAR respectively.
    3574              :          */
    3575          376 :         econtext->ecxt_innertuple = oldslot;
    3576          376 :         econtext->ecxt_outertuple = newslot;
    3577          376 :         if (!ExecQual(*predicate, econtext))
    3578          210 :             return false;
    3579              :     }
    3580              : 
    3581       617625 :     return true;
    3582              : }
    3583              : 
    3584              : 
    3585              : /* ----------
    3586              :  * After-trigger stuff
    3587              :  *
    3588              :  * The AfterTriggersData struct holds data about pending AFTER trigger events
    3589              :  * during the current transaction tree.  (BEFORE triggers are fired
    3590              :  * immediately so we don't need any persistent state about them.)  The struct
    3591              :  * and most of its subsidiary data are kept in TopTransactionContext; however
    3592              :  * some data that can be discarded sooner appears in the CurTransactionContext
    3593              :  * of the relevant subtransaction.  Also, the individual event records are
    3594              :  * kept in a separate sub-context of TopTransactionContext.  This is done
    3595              :  * mainly so that it's easy to tell from a memory context dump how much space
    3596              :  * is being eaten by trigger events.
    3597              :  *
    3598              :  * Because the list of pending events can grow large, we go to some
    3599              :  * considerable effort to minimize per-event memory consumption.  The event
    3600              :  * records are grouped into chunks and common data for similar events in the
    3601              :  * same chunk is only stored once.
    3602              :  *
    3603              :  * XXX We need to be able to save the per-event data in a file if it grows too
    3604              :  * large.
    3605              :  * ----------
    3606              :  */
    3607              : 
    3608              : /* Per-trigger SET CONSTRAINT status */
    3609              : typedef struct SetConstraintTriggerData
    3610              : {
    3611              :     Oid         sct_tgoid;
    3612              :     bool        sct_tgisdeferred;
    3613              : } SetConstraintTriggerData;
    3614              : 
    3615              : typedef struct SetConstraintTriggerData *SetConstraintTrigger;
    3616              : 
    3617              : /*
    3618              :  * SET CONSTRAINT intra-transaction status.
    3619              :  *
    3620              :  * We make this a single palloc'd object so it can be copied and freed easily.
    3621              :  *
    3622              :  * all_isset and all_isdeferred are used to keep track
    3623              :  * of SET CONSTRAINTS ALL {DEFERRED, IMMEDIATE}.
    3624              :  *
    3625              :  * trigstates[] stores per-trigger tgisdeferred settings.
    3626              :  */
    3627              : typedef struct SetConstraintStateData
    3628              : {
    3629              :     bool        all_isset;
    3630              :     bool        all_isdeferred;
    3631              :     int         numstates;      /* number of trigstates[] entries in use */
    3632              :     int         numalloc;       /* allocated size of trigstates[] */
    3633              :     SetConstraintTriggerData trigstates[FLEXIBLE_ARRAY_MEMBER];
    3634              : } SetConstraintStateData;
    3635              : 
    3636              : typedef SetConstraintStateData *SetConstraintState;
    3637              : 
    3638              : 
    3639              : /*
    3640              :  * Per-trigger-event data
    3641              :  *
    3642              :  * The actual per-event data, AfterTriggerEventData, includes DONE/IN_PROGRESS
    3643              :  * status bits, up to two tuple CTIDs, and optionally two OIDs of partitions.
    3644              :  * Each event record also has an associated AfterTriggerSharedData that is
    3645              :  * shared across all instances of similar events within a "chunk".
    3646              :  *
    3647              :  * For row-level triggers, we arrange not to waste storage on unneeded ctid
    3648              :  * fields.  Updates of regular tables use two; inserts and deletes of regular
    3649              :  * tables use one; foreign tables always use zero and save the tuple(s) to a
    3650              :  * tuplestore.  AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH directs AfterTriggerExecute() to
    3651              :  * retrieve a fresh tuple or pair of tuples from that tuplestore, while
    3652              :  * AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE directs it to use the most-recently-retrieved
    3653              :  * tuple(s).  This permits storing tuples once regardless of the number of
    3654              :  * row-level triggers on a foreign table.
    3655              :  *
    3656              :  * When updates on partitioned tables cause rows to move between partitions,
    3657              :  * the OIDs of both partitions are stored too, so that the tuples can be
    3658              :  * fetched; such entries are marked AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE (for "cross-
    3659              :  * partition update").
    3660              :  *
    3661              :  * Note that we need triggers on foreign tables to be fired in exactly the
    3662              :  * order they were queued, so that the tuples come out of the tuplestore in
    3663              :  * the right order.  To ensure that, we forbid deferrable (constraint)
    3664              :  * triggers on foreign tables.  This also ensures that such triggers do not
    3665              :  * get deferred into outer trigger query levels, meaning that it's okay to
    3666              :  * destroy the tuplestore at the end of the query level.
    3667              :  *
    3668              :  * Statement-level triggers always bear AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID, though they
    3669              :  * require no ctid field.  We lack the flag bit space to neatly represent that
    3670              :  * distinct case, and it seems unlikely to be worth much trouble.
    3671              :  *
    3672              :  * Note: ats_firing_id is initially zero and is set to something else when
    3673              :  * AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS is set.  It indicates which trigger firing
    3674              :  * cycle the trigger will be fired in (or was fired in, if DONE is set).
    3675              :  * Although this is mutable state, we can keep it in AfterTriggerSharedData
    3676              :  * because all instances of the same type of event in a given event list will
    3677              :  * be fired at the same time, if they were queued between the same firing
    3678              :  * cycles.  So we need only ensure that ats_firing_id is zero when attaching
    3679              :  * a new event to an existing AfterTriggerSharedData record.
    3680              :  */
    3681              : typedef uint32 TriggerFlags;
    3682              : 
    3683              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET            0x07FFFFFF  /* must be low-order bits */
    3684              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE              0x80000000
    3685              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS       0x40000000
    3686              : /* bits describing the size and tuple sources of this event */
    3687              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE         0x00000000
    3688              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH         0x20000000
    3689              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID             0x10000000
    3690              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID             0x30000000
    3691              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE         0x08000000
    3692              : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS          0x38000000
    3693              : typedef struct AfterTriggerSharedData *AfterTriggerShared;
    3694              : 
    3695              : typedef struct AfterTriggerSharedData
    3696              : {
    3697              :     TriggerEvent ats_event;     /* event type indicator, see trigger.h */
    3698              :     Oid         ats_tgoid;      /* the trigger's ID */
    3699              :     Oid         ats_relid;      /* the relation it's on */
    3700              :     Oid         ats_rolid;      /* role to execute the trigger */
    3701              :     CommandId   ats_firing_id;  /* ID for firing cycle */
    3702              :     struct AfterTriggersTableData *ats_table;   /* transition table access */
    3703              :     Bitmapset  *ats_modifiedcols;   /* modified columns */
    3704              : } AfterTriggerSharedData;
    3705              : 
    3706              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventData *AfterTriggerEvent;
    3707              : 
    3708              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventData
    3709              : {
    3710              :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3711              :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;  /* inserted, deleted, or old updated tuple */
    3712              :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid2;  /* new updated tuple */
    3713              : 
    3714              :     /*
    3715              :      * During a cross-partition update of a partitioned table, we also store
    3716              :      * the OIDs of source and destination partitions that are needed to fetch
    3717              :      * the old (ctid1) and the new tuple (ctid2) from, respectively.
    3718              :      */
    3719              :     Oid         ate_src_part;
    3720              :     Oid         ate_dst_part;
    3721              : } AfterTriggerEventData;
    3722              : 
    3723              : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_src_part, ate_dst_part */
    3724              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids
    3725              : {
    3726              :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;
    3727              :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;
    3728              :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid2;
    3729              : }           AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids;
    3730              : 
    3731              : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_*_part and ate_ctid2 */
    3732              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid
    3733              : {
    3734              :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3735              :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;  /* inserted, deleted, or old updated tuple */
    3736              : }           AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid;
    3737              : 
    3738              : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_*_part, ate_ctid1 and ate_ctid2 */
    3739              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids
    3740              : {
    3741              :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3742              : }           AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids;
    3743              : 
    3744              : #define SizeofTriggerEvent(evt) \
    3745              :     (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE ? \
    3746              :      sizeof(AfterTriggerEventData) : \
    3747              :      (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID ? \
    3748              :       sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids) : \
    3749              :       (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID ? \
    3750              :        sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid) : \
    3751              :        sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids))))
    3752              : 
    3753              : #define GetTriggerSharedData(evt) \
    3754              :     ((AfterTriggerShared) ((char *) (evt) + ((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET)))
    3755              : 
    3756              : /*
    3757              :  * To avoid palloc overhead, we keep trigger events in arrays in successively-
    3758              :  * larger chunks (a slightly more sophisticated version of an expansible
    3759              :  * array).  The space between CHUNK_DATA_START and freeptr is occupied by
    3760              :  * AfterTriggerEventData records; the space between endfree and endptr is
    3761              :  * occupied by AfterTriggerSharedData records.
    3762              :  */
    3763              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventChunk
    3764              : {
    3765              :     struct AfterTriggerEventChunk *next;    /* list link */
    3766              :     char       *freeptr;        /* start of free space in chunk */
    3767              :     char       *endfree;        /* end of free space in chunk */
    3768              :     char       *endptr;         /* end of chunk */
    3769              :     /* event data follows here */
    3770              : } AfterTriggerEventChunk;
    3771              : 
    3772              : #define CHUNK_DATA_START(cptr) ((char *) (cptr) + MAXALIGN(sizeof(AfterTriggerEventChunk)))
    3773              : 
    3774              : /* A list of events */
    3775              : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventList
    3776              : {
    3777              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *head;
    3778              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *tail;
    3779              :     char       *tailfree;       /* freeptr of tail chunk */
    3780              : } AfterTriggerEventList;
    3781              : 
    3782              : /* Macros to help in iterating over a list of events */
    3783              : #define for_each_chunk(cptr, evtlist) \
    3784              :     for (cptr = (evtlist).head; cptr != NULL; cptr = cptr->next)
    3785              : #define for_each_event(eptr, cptr) \
    3786              :     for (eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) CHUNK_DATA_START(cptr); \
    3787              :          (char *) eptr < (cptr)->freeptr; \
    3788              :          eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) (((char *) eptr) + SizeofTriggerEvent(eptr)))
    3789              : /* Use this if no special per-chunk processing is needed */
    3790              : #define for_each_event_chunk(eptr, cptr, evtlist) \
    3791              :     for_each_chunk(cptr, evtlist) for_each_event(eptr, cptr)
    3792              : 
    3793              : /* Macros for iterating from a start point that might not be list start */
    3794              : #define for_each_chunk_from(cptr) \
    3795              :     for (; cptr != NULL; cptr = cptr->next)
    3796              : #define for_each_event_from(eptr, cptr) \
    3797              :     for (; \
    3798              :          (char *) eptr < (cptr)->freeptr; \
    3799              :          eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) (((char *) eptr) + SizeofTriggerEvent(eptr)))
    3800              : 
    3801              : 
    3802              : /*
    3803              :  * All per-transaction data for the AFTER TRIGGERS module.
    3804              :  *
    3805              :  * AfterTriggersData has the following fields:
    3806              :  *
    3807              :  * firing_counter is incremented for each call of afterTriggerInvokeEvents.
    3808              :  * We mark firable events with the current firing cycle's ID so that we can
    3809              :  * tell which ones to work on.  This ensures sane behavior if a trigger
    3810              :  * function chooses to do SET CONSTRAINTS: the inner SET CONSTRAINTS will
    3811              :  * only fire those events that weren't already scheduled for firing.
    3812              :  *
    3813              :  * state keeps track of the transaction-local effects of SET CONSTRAINTS.
    3814              :  * This is saved and restored across failed subtransactions.
    3815              :  *
    3816              :  * events is the current list of deferred events.  This is global across
    3817              :  * all subtransactions of the current transaction.  In a subtransaction
    3818              :  * abort, we know that the events added by the subtransaction are at the
    3819              :  * end of the list, so it is relatively easy to discard them.  The event
    3820              :  * list chunks themselves are stored in event_cxt.
    3821              :  *
    3822              :  * query_depth is the current depth of nested AfterTriggerBeginQuery calls
    3823              :  * (-1 when the stack is empty).
    3824              :  *
    3825              :  * query_stack[query_depth] is the per-query-level data, including these fields:
    3826              :  *
    3827              :  * events is a list of AFTER trigger events queued by the current query.
    3828              :  * None of these are valid until the matching AfterTriggerEndQuery call
    3829              :  * occurs.  At that point we fire immediate-mode triggers, and append any
    3830              :  * deferred events to the main events list.
    3831              :  *
    3832              :  * fdw_tuplestore is a tuplestore containing the foreign-table tuples
    3833              :  * needed by events queued by the current query.  (Note: we use just one
    3834              :  * tuplestore even though more than one foreign table might be involved.
    3835              :  * This is okay because tuplestores don't really care what's in the tuples
    3836              :  * they store; but it's possible that someday it'd break.)
    3837              :  *
    3838              :  * tables is a List of AfterTriggersTableData structs for target tables
    3839              :  * of the current query (see below).
    3840              :  *
    3841              :  * maxquerydepth is just the allocated length of query_stack.
    3842              :  *
    3843              :  * trans_stack holds per-subtransaction data, including these fields:
    3844              :  *
    3845              :  * state is NULL or a pointer to a saved copy of the SET CONSTRAINTS
    3846              :  * state data.  Each subtransaction level that modifies that state first
    3847              :  * saves a copy, which we use to restore the state if we abort.
    3848              :  *
    3849              :  * events is a copy of the events head/tail pointers,
    3850              :  * which we use to restore those values during subtransaction abort.
    3851              :  *
    3852              :  * query_depth is the subtransaction-start-time value of query_depth,
    3853              :  * which we similarly use to clean up at subtransaction abort.
    3854              :  *
    3855              :  * firing_counter is the subtransaction-start-time value of firing_counter.
    3856              :  * We use this to recognize which deferred triggers were fired (or marked
    3857              :  * for firing) within an aborted subtransaction.
    3858              :  *
    3859              :  * We use GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel() to determine the correct array
    3860              :  * index in trans_stack.  maxtransdepth is the number of allocated entries in
    3861              :  * trans_stack.  (By not keeping our own stack pointer, we can avoid trouble
    3862              :  * in cases where errors during subxact abort cause multiple invocations
    3863              :  * of AfterTriggerEndSubXact() at the same nesting depth.)
    3864              :  *
    3865              :  * We create an AfterTriggersTableData struct for each target table of the
    3866              :  * current query, and each operation mode (INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE), that has
    3867              :  * either transition tables or statement-level triggers.  This is used to
    3868              :  * hold the relevant transition tables, as well as info tracking whether
    3869              :  * we already queued the statement triggers.  (We use that info to prevent
    3870              :  * firing the same statement triggers more than once per statement, or really
    3871              :  * once per transition table set.)  These structs, along with the transition
    3872              :  * table tuplestores, live in the (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext.
    3873              :  * That's sufficient lifespan because we don't allow transition tables to be
    3874              :  * used by deferrable triggers, so they only need to survive until
    3875              :  * AfterTriggerEndQuery.
    3876              :  */
    3877              : typedef struct AfterTriggersQueryData AfterTriggersQueryData;
    3878              : typedef struct AfterTriggersTransData AfterTriggersTransData;
    3879              : typedef struct AfterTriggersTableData AfterTriggersTableData;
    3880              : 
    3881              : typedef struct AfterTriggersData
    3882              : {
    3883              :     CommandId   firing_counter; /* next firing ID to assign */
    3884              :     SetConstraintState state;   /* the active S C state */
    3885              :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* deferred-event list */
    3886              :     MemoryContext event_cxt;    /* memory context for events, if any */
    3887              : 
    3888              :     /* per-query-level data: */
    3889              :     AfterTriggersQueryData *query_stack;    /* array of structs shown below */
    3890              :     int         query_depth;    /* current index in above array */
    3891              :     int         maxquerydepth;  /* allocated len of above array */
    3892              : 
    3893              :     /* per-subtransaction-level data: */
    3894              :     AfterTriggersTransData *trans_stack;    /* array of structs shown below */
    3895              :     int         maxtransdepth;  /* allocated len of above array */
    3896              : 
    3897              :     List       *batch_callbacks;    /* List of AfterTriggerCallbackItem; for
    3898              :                                      * deferred constraints */
    3899              :     bool        firing_batch_callbacks; /* true when in
    3900              :                                          * FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks() */
    3901              : 
    3902              :     /*
    3903              :      * Incremented around the trigger-firing loops in AfterTriggerEndQuery,
    3904              :      * AfterTriggerFireDeferred, and AfterTriggerSetState.  Used by
    3905              :      * AfterTriggerIsActive() to signal that after-trigger firing is active.
    3906              :      */
    3907              :     int         firing_depth;
    3908              : } AfterTriggersData;
    3909              : 
    3910              : struct AfterTriggersQueryData
    3911              : {
    3912              :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* events pending from this query */
    3913              :     Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore;    /* foreign tuples for said events */
    3914              :     List       *tables;         /* list of AfterTriggersTableData, see below */
    3915              :     List       *batch_callbacks;    /* List of AfterTriggerCallbackItem */
    3916              : };
    3917              : 
    3918              : struct AfterTriggersTransData
    3919              : {
    3920              :     /* these fields are just for resetting at subtrans abort: */
    3921              :     SetConstraintState state;   /* saved S C state, or NULL if not yet saved */
    3922              :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* saved list pointer */
    3923              :     int         query_depth;    /* saved query_depth */
    3924              :     CommandId   firing_counter; /* saved firing_counter */
    3925              : };
    3926              : 
    3927              : struct AfterTriggersTableData
    3928              : {
    3929              :     /* relid + cmdType form the lookup key for these structs: */
    3930              :     Oid         relid;          /* target table's OID */
    3931              :     CmdType     cmdType;        /* event type, CMD_INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE */
    3932              :     bool        closed;         /* true when no longer OK to add tuples */
    3933              :     bool        before_trig_done;   /* did we already queue BS triggers? */
    3934              :     bool        after_trig_done;    /* did we already queue AS triggers? */
    3935              :     AfterTriggerEventList after_trig_events;    /* if so, saved list pointer */
    3936              : 
    3937              :     /* "old" transition table for UPDATE/DELETE, if any */
    3938              :     Tuplestorestate *old_tuplestore;
    3939              :     /* "new" transition table for INSERT/UPDATE, if any */
    3940              :     Tuplestorestate *new_tuplestore;
    3941              : 
    3942              :     TupleTableSlot *storeslot;  /* for converting to tuplestore's format */
    3943              : };
    3944              : 
    3945              : /* Entry in afterTriggers.batch_callbacks */
    3946              : typedef struct AfterTriggerCallbackItem
    3947              : {
    3948              :     AfterTriggerBatchCallback callback;
    3949              :     void       *arg;
    3950              : } AfterTriggerCallbackItem;
    3951              : 
    3952              : static AfterTriggersData afterTriggers;
    3953              : 
    3954              : static void AfterTriggerExecute(EState *estate,
    3955              :                                 AfterTriggerEvent event,
    3956              :                                 ResultRelInfo *relInfo,
    3957              :                                 ResultRelInfo *src_relInfo,
    3958              :                                 ResultRelInfo *dst_relInfo,
    3959              :                                 TriggerDesc *trigdesc,
    3960              :                                 FmgrInfo *finfo,
    3961              :                                 TriggerInstrumentation *instr,
    3962              :                                 MemoryContext per_tuple_context,
    3963              :                                 TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot1,
    3964              :                                 TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot2);
    3965              : static AfterTriggersTableData *GetAfterTriggersTableData(Oid relid,
    3966              :                                                          CmdType cmdType);
    3967              : static TupleTableSlot *GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(AfterTriggersTableData *table,
    3968              :                                                  TupleDesc tupdesc);
    3969              : static Tuplestorestate *GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(int event,
    3970              :                                                         TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    3971              :                                                         TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    3972              :                                                         TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture);
    3973              : static void TransitionTableAddTuple(EState *estate,
    3974              :                                     int event,
    3975              :                                     TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    3976              :                                     ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3977              :                                     TupleTableSlot *slot,
    3978              :                                     TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple,
    3979              :                                     Tuplestorestate *tuplestore);
    3980              : static void AfterTriggerFreeQuery(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs);
    3981              : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateCreate(int numalloc);
    3982              : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateCopy(SetConstraintState origstate);
    3983              : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateAddItem(SetConstraintState state,
    3984              :                                                     Oid tgoid, bool tgisdeferred);
    3985              : static void cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType, int tgevent);
    3986              : 
    3987              : static void FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks(List *callbacks);
    3988              : 
    3989              : /*
    3990              :  * Get the FDW tuplestore for the current trigger query level, creating it
    3991              :  * if necessary.
    3992              :  */
    3993              : static Tuplestorestate *
    3994           50 : GetCurrentFDWTuplestore(void)
    3995              : {
    3996              :     Tuplestorestate *ret;
    3997              : 
    3998           50 :     ret = afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].fdw_tuplestore;
    3999           50 :     if (ret == NULL)
    4000              :     {
    4001              :         MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4002              :         ResourceOwner saveResourceOwner;
    4003              : 
    4004              :         /*
    4005              :          * Make the tuplestore valid until end of subtransaction.  We really
    4006              :          * only need it until AfterTriggerEndQuery().
    4007              :          */
    4008           18 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4009           18 :         saveResourceOwner = CurrentResourceOwner;
    4010           18 :         CurrentResourceOwner = CurTransactionResourceOwner;
    4011              : 
    4012           18 :         ret = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    4013              : 
    4014           18 :         CurrentResourceOwner = saveResourceOwner;
    4015           18 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4016              : 
    4017           18 :         afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].fdw_tuplestore = ret;
    4018              :     }
    4019              : 
    4020           50 :     return ret;
    4021              : }
    4022              : 
    4023              : /* ----------
    4024              :  * afterTriggerCheckState()
    4025              :  *
    4026              :  *  Returns true if the trigger event is actually in state DEFERRED.
    4027              :  * ----------
    4028              :  */
    4029              : static bool
    4030       609816 : afterTriggerCheckState(AfterTriggerShared evtshared)
    4031              : {
    4032       609816 :     Oid         tgoid = evtshared->ats_tgoid;
    4033       609816 :     SetConstraintState state = afterTriggers.state;
    4034              :     int         i;
    4035              : 
    4036              :     /*
    4037              :      * For not-deferrable triggers (i.e. normal AFTER ROW triggers and
    4038              :      * constraints declared NOT DEFERRABLE), the state is always false.
    4039              :      */
    4040       609816 :     if ((evtshared->ats_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE) == 0)
    4041       609275 :         return false;
    4042              : 
    4043              :     /*
    4044              :      * If constraint state exists, SET CONSTRAINTS might have been executed
    4045              :      * either for this trigger or for all triggers.
    4046              :      */
    4047          541 :     if (state != NULL)
    4048              :     {
    4049              :         /* Check for SET CONSTRAINTS for this specific trigger. */
    4050          222 :         for (i = 0; i < state->numstates; i++)
    4051              :         {
    4052          167 :             if (state->trigstates[i].sct_tgoid == tgoid)
    4053           40 :                 return state->trigstates[i].sct_tgisdeferred;
    4054              :         }
    4055              : 
    4056              :         /* Check for SET CONSTRAINTS ALL. */
    4057           55 :         if (state->all_isset)
    4058           47 :             return state->all_isdeferred;
    4059              :     }
    4060              : 
    4061              :     /*
    4062              :      * Otherwise return the default state for the trigger.
    4063              :      */
    4064          454 :     return ((evtshared->ats_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED) != 0);
    4065              : }
    4066              : 
    4067              : /* ----------
    4068              :  * afterTriggerCopyBitmap()
    4069              :  *
    4070              :  * Copy bitmap into AfterTriggerEvents memory context, which is where the after
    4071              :  * trigger events are kept.
    4072              :  * ----------
    4073              :  */
    4074              : static Bitmapset *
    4075         7629 : afterTriggerCopyBitmap(Bitmapset *src)
    4076              : {
    4077              :     Bitmapset  *dst;
    4078              :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4079              : 
    4080         7629 :     if (src == NULL)
    4081         5406 :         return NULL;
    4082              : 
    4083         2223 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(afterTriggers.event_cxt);
    4084              : 
    4085         2223 :     dst = bms_copy(src);
    4086              : 
    4087         2223 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4088              : 
    4089         2223 :     return dst;
    4090              : }
    4091              : 
    4092              : /* ----------
    4093              :  * afterTriggerAddEvent()
    4094              :  *
    4095              :  *  Add a new trigger event to the specified queue.
    4096              :  *  The passed-in event data is copied.
    4097              :  * ----------
    4098              :  */
    4099              : static void
    4100       610301 : afterTriggerAddEvent(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4101              :                      AfterTriggerEvent event, AfterTriggerShared evtshared)
    4102              : {
    4103       610301 :     Size        eventsize = SizeofTriggerEvent(event);
    4104       610301 :     Size        needed = eventsize + sizeof(AfterTriggerSharedData);
    4105              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4106              :     AfterTriggerShared newshared;
    4107              :     AfterTriggerEvent newevent;
    4108              : 
    4109              :     /*
    4110              :      * If empty list or not enough room in the tail chunk, make a new chunk.
    4111              :      * We assume here that a new shared record will always be needed.
    4112              :      */
    4113       610301 :     chunk = events->tail;
    4114       610301 :     if (chunk == NULL ||
    4115       604918 :         chunk->endfree - chunk->freeptr < needed)
    4116              :     {
    4117              :         Size        chunksize;
    4118              : 
    4119              :         /* Create event context if we didn't already */
    4120         5437 :         if (afterTriggers.event_cxt == NULL)
    4121         4475 :             afterTriggers.event_cxt =
    4122         4475 :                 AllocSetContextCreate(TopTransactionContext,
    4123              :                                       "AfterTriggerEvents",
    4124              :                                       ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4125              : 
    4126              :         /*
    4127              :          * Chunk size starts at 1KB and is allowed to increase up to 1MB.
    4128              :          * These numbers are fairly arbitrary, though there is a hard limit at
    4129              :          * AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET; else we couldn't link event records to their
    4130              :          * shared records using the available space in ate_flags.  Another
    4131              :          * constraint is that if the chunk size gets too huge, the search loop
    4132              :          * below would get slow given a (not too common) usage pattern with
    4133              :          * many distinct event types in a chunk.  Therefore, we double the
    4134              :          * preceding chunk size only if there weren't too many shared records
    4135              :          * in the preceding chunk; otherwise we halve it.  This gives us some
    4136              :          * ability to adapt to the actual usage pattern of the current query
    4137              :          * while still having large chunk sizes in typical usage.  All chunk
    4138              :          * sizes used should be MAXALIGN multiples, to ensure that the shared
    4139              :          * records will be aligned safely.
    4140              :          */
    4141              : #define MIN_CHUNK_SIZE 1024
    4142              : #define MAX_CHUNK_SIZE (1024*1024)
    4143              : 
    4144              : #if MAX_CHUNK_SIZE > (AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET+1)
    4145              : #error MAX_CHUNK_SIZE must not exceed AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET
    4146              : #endif
    4147              : 
    4148         5437 :         if (chunk == NULL)
    4149         5383 :             chunksize = MIN_CHUNK_SIZE;
    4150              :         else
    4151              :         {
    4152              :             /* preceding chunk size... */
    4153           54 :             chunksize = chunk->endptr - (char *) chunk;
    4154              :             /* check number of shared records in preceding chunk */
    4155           54 :             if ((chunk->endptr - chunk->endfree) <=
    4156              :                 (100 * sizeof(AfterTriggerSharedData)))
    4157           54 :                 chunksize *= 2; /* okay, double it */
    4158              :             else
    4159            0 :                 chunksize /= 2; /* too many shared records */
    4160           54 :             chunksize = Min(chunksize, MAX_CHUNK_SIZE);
    4161              :         }
    4162         5437 :         chunk = MemoryContextAlloc(afterTriggers.event_cxt, chunksize);
    4163         5437 :         chunk->next = NULL;
    4164         5437 :         chunk->freeptr = CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    4165         5437 :         chunk->endptr = chunk->endfree = (char *) chunk + chunksize;
    4166              :         Assert(chunk->endfree - chunk->freeptr >= needed);
    4167              : 
    4168         5437 :         if (events->tail == NULL)
    4169              :         {
    4170              :             Assert(events->head == NULL);
    4171         5383 :             events->head = chunk;
    4172              :         }
    4173              :         else
    4174           54 :             events->tail->next = chunk;
    4175         5437 :         events->tail = chunk;
    4176              :         /* events->tailfree is now out of sync, but we'll fix it below */
    4177              :     }
    4178              : 
    4179              :     /*
    4180              :      * Try to locate a matching shared-data record already in the chunk. If
    4181              :      * none, make a new one. The search begins with the most recently added
    4182              :      * record, since newer ones are most likely to match.
    4183              :      */
    4184       610301 :     for (newshared = (AfterTriggerShared) chunk->endfree;
    4185       813868 :          (char *) newshared < chunk->endptr;
    4186       203567 :          newshared++)
    4187              :     {
    4188              :         /* compare fields roughly by probability of them being different */
    4189       806239 :         if (newshared->ats_tgoid == evtshared->ats_tgoid &&
    4190       602817 :             newshared->ats_event == evtshared->ats_event &&
    4191       602813 :             newshared->ats_firing_id == 0 &&
    4192       602697 :             newshared->ats_table == evtshared->ats_table &&
    4193       602697 :             newshared->ats_relid == evtshared->ats_relid &&
    4194      1205390 :             newshared->ats_rolid == evtshared->ats_rolid &&
    4195       602693 :             bms_equal(newshared->ats_modifiedcols,
    4196       602693 :                       evtshared->ats_modifiedcols))
    4197       602672 :             break;
    4198              :     }
    4199       610301 :     if ((char *) newshared >= chunk->endptr)
    4200              :     {
    4201         7629 :         newshared = ((AfterTriggerShared) chunk->endfree) - 1;
    4202         7629 :         *newshared = *evtshared;
    4203              :         /* now we must make a suitably-long-lived copy of the bitmap */
    4204         7629 :         newshared->ats_modifiedcols = afterTriggerCopyBitmap(evtshared->ats_modifiedcols);
    4205         7629 :         newshared->ats_firing_id = 0;    /* just to be sure */
    4206         7629 :         chunk->endfree = (char *) newshared;
    4207              :     }
    4208              : 
    4209              :     /* Insert the data */
    4210       610301 :     newevent = (AfterTriggerEvent) chunk->freeptr;
    4211       610301 :     memcpy(newevent, event, eventsize);
    4212              :     /* ... and link the new event to its shared record */
    4213       610301 :     newevent->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET;
    4214       610301 :     newevent->ate_flags |= (char *) newshared - (char *) newevent;
    4215              : 
    4216       610301 :     chunk->freeptr += eventsize;
    4217       610301 :     events->tailfree = chunk->freeptr;
    4218       610301 : }
    4219              : 
    4220              : /* ----------
    4221              :  * afterTriggerFreeEventList()
    4222              :  *
    4223              :  *  Free all the event storage in the given list.
    4224              :  * ----------
    4225              :  */
    4226              : static void
    4227        10594 : afterTriggerFreeEventList(AfterTriggerEventList *events)
    4228              : {
    4229              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4230              : 
    4231        14950 :     while ((chunk = events->head) != NULL)
    4232              :     {
    4233         4356 :         events->head = chunk->next;
    4234         4356 :         pfree(chunk);
    4235              :     }
    4236        10594 :     events->tail = NULL;
    4237        10594 :     events->tailfree = NULL;
    4238        10594 : }
    4239              : 
    4240              : /* ----------
    4241              :  * afterTriggerRestoreEventList()
    4242              :  *
    4243              :  *  Restore an event list to its prior length, removing all the events
    4244              :  *  added since it had the value old_events.
    4245              :  * ----------
    4246              :  */
    4247              : static void
    4248         5396 : afterTriggerRestoreEventList(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4249              :                              const AfterTriggerEventList *old_events)
    4250              : {
    4251              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4252              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *next_chunk;
    4253              : 
    4254         5396 :     if (old_events->tail == NULL)
    4255              :     {
    4256              :         /* restoring to a completely empty state, so free everything */
    4257         5382 :         afterTriggerFreeEventList(events);
    4258              :     }
    4259              :     else
    4260              :     {
    4261           14 :         *events = *old_events;
    4262              :         /* free any chunks after the last one we want to keep */
    4263           14 :         for (chunk = events->tail->next; chunk != NULL; chunk = next_chunk)
    4264              :         {
    4265            0 :             next_chunk = chunk->next;
    4266            0 :             pfree(chunk);
    4267              :         }
    4268              :         /* and clean up the tail chunk to be the right length */
    4269           14 :         events->tail->next = NULL;
    4270           14 :         events->tail->freeptr = events->tailfree;
    4271              : 
    4272              :         /*
    4273              :          * We don't make any effort to remove now-unused shared data records.
    4274              :          * They might still be useful, anyway.
    4275              :          */
    4276              :     }
    4277         5396 : }
    4278              : 
    4279              : /* ----------
    4280              :  * afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk()
    4281              :  *
    4282              :  *  Remove the first chunk of events from the query level's event list.
    4283              :  *  Keep any event list pointers elsewhere in the query level's data
    4284              :  *  structures in sync.
    4285              :  * ----------
    4286              :  */
    4287              : static void
    4288            0 : afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs)
    4289              : {
    4290            0 :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *target = qs->events.head;
    4291              :     ListCell   *lc;
    4292              : 
    4293              :     Assert(target && target->next);
    4294              : 
    4295              :     /*
    4296              :      * First, update any pointers in the per-table data, so that they won't be
    4297              :      * dangling.  Resetting obsoleted pointers to NULL will make
    4298              :      * cancel_prior_stmt_triggers start from the list head, which is fine.
    4299              :      */
    4300            0 :     foreach(lc, qs->tables)
    4301              :     {
    4302            0 :         AfterTriggersTableData *table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    4303              : 
    4304            0 :         if (table->after_trig_done &&
    4305            0 :             table->after_trig_events.tail == target)
    4306              :         {
    4307            0 :             table->after_trig_events.head = NULL;
    4308            0 :             table->after_trig_events.tail = NULL;
    4309            0 :             table->after_trig_events.tailfree = NULL;
    4310              :         }
    4311              :     }
    4312              : 
    4313              :     /* Now we can flush the head chunk */
    4314            0 :     qs->events.head = target->next;
    4315            0 :     pfree(target);
    4316            0 : }
    4317              : 
    4318              : 
    4319              : /* ----------
    4320              :  * AfterTriggerExecute()
    4321              :  *
    4322              :  *  Fetch the required tuples back from the heap and fire one
    4323              :  *  single trigger function.
    4324              :  *
    4325              :  *  Frequently, this will be fired many times in a row for triggers of
    4326              :  *  a single relation.  Therefore, we cache the open relation and provide
    4327              :  *  fmgr lookup cache space at the caller level.  (For triggers fired at
    4328              :  *  the end of a query, we can even piggyback on the executor's state.)
    4329              :  *
    4330              :  *  When fired for a cross-partition update of a partitioned table, the old
    4331              :  *  tuple is fetched using 'src_relInfo' (the source leaf partition) and
    4332              :  *  the new tuple using 'dst_relInfo' (the destination leaf partition), though
    4333              :  *  both are converted into the root partitioned table's format before passing
    4334              :  *  to the trigger function.
    4335              :  *
    4336              :  *  event: event currently being fired.
    4337              :  *  relInfo: result relation for event.
    4338              :  *  src_relInfo: source partition of a cross-partition update
    4339              :  *  dst_relInfo: its destination partition
    4340              :  *  trigdesc: working copy of rel's trigger info.
    4341              :  *  finfo: array of fmgr lookup cache entries (one per trigger in trigdesc).
    4342              :  *  instr: array of EXPLAIN ANALYZE instrumentation nodes (one per trigger),
    4343              :  *      or NULL if no instrumentation is wanted.
    4344              :  *  per_tuple_context: memory context to call trigger function in.
    4345              :  *  trig_tuple_slot1: scratch slot for tg_trigtuple (foreign tables only)
    4346              :  *  trig_tuple_slot2: scratch slot for tg_newtuple (foreign tables only)
    4347              :  * ----------
    4348              :  */
    4349              : static void
    4350       609634 : AfterTriggerExecute(EState *estate,
    4351              :                     AfterTriggerEvent event,
    4352              :                     ResultRelInfo *relInfo,
    4353              :                     ResultRelInfo *src_relInfo,
    4354              :                     ResultRelInfo *dst_relInfo,
    4355              :                     TriggerDesc *trigdesc,
    4356              :                     FmgrInfo *finfo, TriggerInstrumentation *instr,
    4357              :                     MemoryContext per_tuple_context,
    4358              :                     TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot1,
    4359              :                     TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot2)
    4360              : {
    4361       609634 :     Relation    rel = relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4362       609634 :     Relation    src_rel = src_relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4363       609634 :     Relation    dst_rel = dst_relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4364       609634 :     AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4365       609634 :     Oid         tgoid = evtshared->ats_tgoid;
    4366       609634 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    4367              :     Oid         save_rolid;
    4368              :     int         save_sec_context;
    4369              :     HeapTuple   rettuple;
    4370              :     int         tgindx;
    4371       609634 :     bool        should_free_trig = false;
    4372       609634 :     bool        should_free_new = false;
    4373              : 
    4374              :     /*
    4375              :      * Locate trigger in trigdesc.  It might not be present, and in fact the
    4376              :      * trigdesc could be NULL, if the trigger was dropped since the event was
    4377              :      * queued.  In that case, silently do nothing.
    4378              :      */
    4379       609634 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    4380            4 :         return;
    4381      1019470 :     for (tgindx = 0; tgindx < trigdesc->numtriggers; tgindx++)
    4382              :     {
    4383      1019470 :         if (trigdesc->triggers[tgindx].tgoid == tgoid)
    4384              :         {
    4385       609630 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = &(trigdesc->triggers[tgindx]);
    4386       609630 :             break;
    4387              :         }
    4388              :     }
    4389       609630 :     if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger == NULL)
    4390            0 :         return;
    4391              : 
    4392              :     /*
    4393              :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, start charging time to this trigger. We want
    4394              :      * to include time spent re-fetching tuples in the trigger cost.
    4395              :      */
    4396       609630 :     if (instr)
    4397            0 :         InstrStartTrigger(instr + tgindx);
    4398              : 
    4399              :     /*
    4400              :      * Fetch the required tuple(s).
    4401              :      */
    4402       609630 :     switch (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS)
    4403              :     {
    4404           25 :         case AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH:
    4405              :             {
    4406           25 :                 Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore = GetCurrentFDWTuplestore();
    4407              : 
    4408           25 :                 if (!tuplestore_gettupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, true, false,
    4409              :                                              trig_tuple_slot1))
    4410            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple1 for AFTER trigger");
    4411              : 
    4412           25 :                 if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) ==
    4413            9 :                     TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE &&
    4414            9 :                     !tuplestore_gettupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, true, false,
    4415              :                                              trig_tuple_slot2))
    4416            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple2 for AFTER trigger");
    4417              :             }
    4418              :             pg_fallthrough;
    4419              :         case AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE:
    4420              : 
    4421              :             /*
    4422              :              * Store tuple in the slot so that tg_trigtuple does not reference
    4423              :              * tuplestore memory.  (It is formally possible for the trigger
    4424              :              * function to queue trigger events that add to the same
    4425              :              * tuplestore, which can push other tuples out of memory.)  The
    4426              :              * distinction is academic, because we start with a minimal tuple
    4427              :              * that is stored as a heap tuple, constructed in different memory
    4428              :              * context, in the slot anyway.
    4429              :              */
    4430           29 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = trig_tuple_slot1;
    4431           29 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple =
    4432           29 :                 ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(trig_tuple_slot1, true, &should_free_trig);
    4433              : 
    4434           29 :             if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) ==
    4435              :                 TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE)
    4436              :             {
    4437           11 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = trig_tuple_slot2;
    4438           11 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple =
    4439           11 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(trig_tuple_slot2, true, &should_free_new);
    4440              :             }
    4441              :             else
    4442              :             {
    4443           18 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = NULL;
    4444              :             }
    4445           29 :             break;
    4446              : 
    4447       609601 :         default:
    4448       609601 :             if (ItemPointerIsValid(&(event->ate_ctid1)))
    4449              :             {
    4450       608845 :                 TupleTableSlot *src_slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate,
    4451              :                                                                  src_relInfo);
    4452              : 
    4453       608845 :                 if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(src_rel,
    4454              :                                                    &(event->ate_ctid1),
    4455              :                                                    SnapshotAny,
    4456              :                                                    src_slot))
    4457            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple1 for AFTER trigger");
    4458              : 
    4459              :                 /*
    4460              :                  * Store the tuple fetched from the source partition into the
    4461              :                  * target (root partitioned) table slot, converting if needed.
    4462              :                  */
    4463       608845 :                 if (src_relInfo != relInfo)
    4464              :                 {
    4465          100 :                     TupleConversionMap *map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(src_relInfo);
    4466              : 
    4467          100 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relInfo);
    4468          100 :                     if (map)
    4469              :                     {
    4470           24 :                         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    4471              :                                               src_slot,
    4472              :                                               LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot);
    4473              :                     }
    4474              :                     else
    4475           76 :                         ExecCopySlot(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot, src_slot);
    4476              :                 }
    4477              :                 else
    4478       608745 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = src_slot;
    4479       608845 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple =
    4480       608845 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot, false, &should_free_trig);
    4481              :             }
    4482              :             else
    4483              :             {
    4484          756 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = NULL;
    4485              :             }
    4486              : 
    4487              :             /* don't touch ctid2 if not there */
    4488       609601 :             if (((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID ||
    4489       609701 :                  (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE)) &&
    4490         2094 :                 ItemPointerIsValid(&(event->ate_ctid2)))
    4491         2094 :             {
    4492         2094 :                 TupleTableSlot *dst_slot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate,
    4493              :                                                                  dst_relInfo);
    4494              : 
    4495         2094 :                 if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(dst_rel,
    4496              :                                                    &(event->ate_ctid2),
    4497              :                                                    SnapshotAny,
    4498              :                                                    dst_slot))
    4499            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple2 for AFTER trigger");
    4500              : 
    4501              :                 /*
    4502              :                  * Store the tuple fetched from the destination partition into
    4503              :                  * the target (root partitioned) table slot, converting if
    4504              :                  * needed.
    4505              :                  */
    4506         2094 :                 if (dst_relInfo != relInfo)
    4507              :                 {
    4508          100 :                     TupleConversionMap *map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(dst_relInfo);
    4509              : 
    4510          100 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate, relInfo);
    4511          100 :                     if (map)
    4512              :                     {
    4513           28 :                         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    4514              :                                               dst_slot,
    4515              :                                               LocTriggerData.tg_newslot);
    4516              :                     }
    4517              :                     else
    4518           72 :                         ExecCopySlot(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot, dst_slot);
    4519              :                 }
    4520              :                 else
    4521         1994 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = dst_slot;
    4522         2094 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple =
    4523         2094 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot, false, &should_free_new);
    4524              :             }
    4525              :             else
    4526              :             {
    4527       607507 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = NULL;
    4528              :             }
    4529              :     }
    4530              : 
    4531              :     /*
    4532              :      * Set up the tuplestore information to let the trigger have access to
    4533              :      * transition tables.  When we first make a transition table available to
    4534              :      * a trigger, mark it "closed" so that it cannot change anymore.  If any
    4535              :      * additional events of the same type get queued in the current trigger
    4536              :      * query level, they'll go into new transition tables.
    4537              :      */
    4538       609630 :     LocTriggerData.tg_oldtable = LocTriggerData.tg_newtable = NULL;
    4539       609630 :     if (evtshared->ats_table)
    4540              :     {
    4541          435 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgoldtable)
    4542              :         {
    4543          231 :             LocTriggerData.tg_oldtable = evtshared->ats_table->old_tuplestore;
    4544          231 :             evtshared->ats_table->closed = true;
    4545              :         }
    4546              : 
    4547          435 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgnewtable)
    4548              :         {
    4549          319 :             LocTriggerData.tg_newtable = evtshared->ats_table->new_tuplestore;
    4550          319 :             evtshared->ats_table->closed = true;
    4551              :         }
    4552              :     }
    4553              : 
    4554              :     /*
    4555              :      * Setup the remaining trigger information
    4556              :      */
    4557       609630 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    4558       609630 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event =
    4559       609630 :         evtshared->ats_event & (TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK | TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW);
    4560       609630 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = rel;
    4561       609630 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgtype))
    4562         3640 :         LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = evtshared->ats_modifiedcols;
    4563              : 
    4564       609630 :     MemoryContextReset(per_tuple_context);
    4565              : 
    4566              :     /*
    4567              :      * If necessary, become the role that was active when the trigger got
    4568              :      * queued.  Note that the role might have been dropped since the trigger
    4569              :      * was queued, but if that is a problem, we will get an error later.
    4570              :      * Checking here would still leave a race condition.
    4571              :      */
    4572       609630 :     GetUserIdAndSecContext(&save_rolid, &save_sec_context);
    4573       609630 :     if (save_rolid != evtshared->ats_rolid)
    4574           16 :         SetUserIdAndSecContext(evtshared->ats_rolid,
    4575              :                                save_sec_context | SECURITY_LOCAL_USERID_CHANGE);
    4576              : 
    4577              :     /*
    4578              :      * Call the trigger and throw away any possibly returned updated tuple.
    4579              :      * (Don't let ExecCallTriggerFunc measure EXPLAIN time.)
    4580              :      */
    4581       609630 :     rettuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    4582              :                                    tgindx,
    4583              :                                    finfo,
    4584              :                                    NULL,
    4585              :                                    per_tuple_context);
    4586       609016 :     if (rettuple != NULL &&
    4587         2361 :         rettuple != LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple &&
    4588          979 :         rettuple != LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple)
    4589            0 :         heap_freetuple(rettuple);
    4590              : 
    4591              :     /* Restore the current role if necessary */
    4592       609016 :     if (save_rolid != evtshared->ats_rolid)
    4593           12 :         SetUserIdAndSecContext(save_rolid, save_sec_context);
    4594              : 
    4595              :     /*
    4596              :      * Release resources
    4597              :      */
    4598       609016 :     if (should_free_trig)
    4599          109 :         heap_freetuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple);
    4600       609016 :     if (should_free_new)
    4601           91 :         heap_freetuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple);
    4602              : 
    4603              :     /* don't clear slots' contents if foreign table */
    4604       609016 :     if (trig_tuple_slot1 == NULL)
    4605              :     {
    4606       608981 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot)
    4607       608263 :             ExecClearTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot);
    4608       608981 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_newslot)
    4609         1897 :             ExecClearTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot);
    4610              :     }
    4611              : 
    4612              :     /*
    4613              :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, stop charging time to this trigger, and count
    4614              :      * the firing of the trigger.
    4615              :      */
    4616       609016 :     if (instr)
    4617            0 :         InstrStopTrigger(instr + tgindx, 1);
    4618              : }
    4619              : 
    4620              : 
    4621              : /*
    4622              :  * afterTriggerMarkEvents()
    4623              :  *
    4624              :  *  Scan the given event list for not yet invoked events.  Mark the ones
    4625              :  *  that can be invoked now with the current firing ID.
    4626              :  *
    4627              :  *  If move_list isn't NULL, events that are not to be invoked now are
    4628              :  *  transferred to move_list.
    4629              :  *
    4630              :  *  When immediate_only is true, do not invoke currently-deferred triggers.
    4631              :  *  (This will be false only at main transaction exit.)
    4632              :  *
    4633              :  *  Returns true if any invokable events were found.
    4634              :  */
    4635              : static bool
    4636       598886 : afterTriggerMarkEvents(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4637              :                        AfterTriggerEventList *move_list,
    4638              :                        bool immediate_only)
    4639              : {
    4640       598886 :     bool        found = false;
    4641       598886 :     bool        deferred_found = false;
    4642              :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    4643              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4644              : 
    4645      1215252 :     for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, *events)
    4646              :     {
    4647       610771 :         AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4648       610771 :         bool        defer_it = false;
    4649              : 
    4650       610771 :         if (!(event->ate_flags &
    4651              :               (AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS)))
    4652              :         {
    4653              :             /*
    4654              :              * This trigger hasn't been called or scheduled yet. Check if we
    4655              :              * should call it now.
    4656              :              */
    4657       610195 :             if (immediate_only && afterTriggerCheckState(evtshared))
    4658              :             {
    4659          451 :                 defer_it = true;
    4660              :             }
    4661              :             else
    4662              :             {
    4663              :                 /*
    4664              :                  * Mark it as to be fired in this firing cycle.
    4665              :                  */
    4666       609744 :                 evtshared->ats_firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter;
    4667       609744 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    4668       609744 :                 found = true;
    4669              :             }
    4670              :         }
    4671              : 
    4672              :         /*
    4673              :          * If it's deferred, move it to move_list, if requested.
    4674              :          */
    4675       610771 :         if (defer_it && move_list != NULL)
    4676              :         {
    4677          451 :             deferred_found = true;
    4678              :             /* add it to move_list */
    4679          451 :             afterTriggerAddEvent(move_list, event, evtshared);
    4680              :             /* mark original copy "done" so we don't do it again */
    4681          451 :             event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    4682              :         }
    4683              :     }
    4684              : 
    4685              :     /*
    4686              :      * We could allow deferred triggers if, before the end of the
    4687              :      * security-restricted operation, we were to verify that a SET CONSTRAINTS
    4688              :      * ... IMMEDIATE has fired all such triggers.  For now, don't bother.
    4689              :      */
    4690       598886 :     if (deferred_found && InSecurityRestrictedOperation())
    4691            8 :         ereport(ERROR,
    4692              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    4693              :                  errmsg("cannot fire deferred trigger within security-restricted operation")));
    4694              : 
    4695       598878 :     return found;
    4696              : }
    4697              : 
    4698              : /*
    4699              :  * afterTriggerInvokeEvents()
    4700              :  *
    4701              :  *  Scan the given event list for events that are marked as to be fired
    4702              :  *  in the current firing cycle, and fire them.
    4703              :  *
    4704              :  *  If estate isn't NULL, we use its result relation info to avoid repeated
    4705              :  *  openings and closing of trigger target relations.  If it is NULL, we
    4706              :  *  make one locally to cache the info in case there are multiple trigger
    4707              :  *  events per rel.
    4708              :  *
    4709              :  *  When delete_ok is true, it's safe to delete fully-processed events.
    4710              :  *  (We are not very tense about that: we simply reset a chunk to be empty
    4711              :  *  if all its events got fired.  The objective here is just to avoid useless
    4712              :  *  rescanning of events when a trigger queues new events during transaction
    4713              :  *  end, so it's not necessary to worry much about the case where only
    4714              :  *  some events are fired.)
    4715              :  *
    4716              :  *  Returns true if no unfired events remain in the list (this allows us
    4717              :  *  to avoid repeating afterTriggerMarkEvents).
    4718              :  */
    4719              : static bool
    4720         5194 : afterTriggerInvokeEvents(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4721              :                          CommandId firing_id,
    4722              :                          EState *estate,
    4723              :                          bool delete_ok)
    4724              : {
    4725         5194 :     bool        all_fired = true;
    4726              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4727              :     MemoryContext per_tuple_context;
    4728         5194 :     bool        local_estate = false;
    4729         5194 :     ResultRelInfo *rInfo = NULL;
    4730         5194 :     Relation    rel = NULL;
    4731         5194 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = NULL;
    4732         5194 :     FmgrInfo   *finfo = NULL;
    4733         5194 :     TriggerInstrumentation *instr = NULL;
    4734         5194 :     TupleTableSlot *slot1 = NULL,
    4735         5194 :                *slot2 = NULL;
    4736              : 
    4737              :     /* Make a local EState if need be */
    4738         5194 :     if (estate == NULL)
    4739              :     {
    4740          252 :         estate = CreateExecutorState();
    4741          252 :         local_estate = true;
    4742              :     }
    4743              : 
    4744              :     /* Make a per-tuple memory context for trigger function calls */
    4745              :     per_tuple_context =
    4746         5194 :         AllocSetContextCreate(CurrentMemoryContext,
    4747              :                               "AfterTriggerTupleContext",
    4748              :                               ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4749              : 
    4750         9828 :     for_each_chunk(chunk, *events)
    4751              :     {
    4752              :         AfterTriggerEvent event;
    4753         5248 :         bool        all_fired_in_chunk = true;
    4754              : 
    4755       615280 :         for_each_event(event, chunk)
    4756              :         {
    4757       610646 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4758              : 
    4759              :             /*
    4760              :              * Is it one for me to fire?
    4761              :              */
    4762       610646 :             if ((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS) &&
    4763       609634 :                 evtshared->ats_firing_id == firing_id)
    4764       609020 :             {
    4765              :                 ResultRelInfo *src_rInfo,
    4766              :                            *dst_rInfo;
    4767              : 
    4768              :                 /*
    4769              :                  * So let's fire it... but first, find the correct relation if
    4770              :                  * this is not the same relation as before.
    4771              :                  */
    4772       609634 :                 if (rel == NULL || RelationGetRelid(rel) != evtshared->ats_relid)
    4773              :                 {
    4774         5419 :                     rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate, evtshared->ats_relid,
    4775              :                                                     NULL);
    4776         5419 :                     rel = rInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4777              :                     /* Catch calls with insufficient relcache refcounting */
    4778              :                     Assert(!RelationHasReferenceCountZero(rel));
    4779         5419 :                     trigdesc = rInfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    4780              :                     /* caution: trigdesc could be NULL here */
    4781         5419 :                     finfo = rInfo->ri_TrigFunctions;
    4782         5419 :                     instr = rInfo->ri_TrigInstrument;
    4783         5419 :                     if (slot1 != NULL)
    4784              :                     {
    4785            0 :                         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot1);
    4786            0 :                         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot2);
    4787            0 :                         slot1 = slot2 = NULL;
    4788              :                     }
    4789         5419 :                     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
    4790              :                     {
    4791           19 :                         slot1 = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(rel->rd_att,
    4792              :                                                          &TTSOpsMinimalTuple);
    4793           19 :                         slot2 = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(rel->rd_att,
    4794              :                                                          &TTSOpsMinimalTuple);
    4795              :                     }
    4796              :                 }
    4797              : 
    4798              :                 /*
    4799              :                  * Look up source and destination partition result rels of a
    4800              :                  * cross-partition update event.
    4801              :                  */
    4802       609634 :                 if ((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) ==
    4803              :                     AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE)
    4804              :                 {
    4805              :                     Assert(OidIsValid(event->ate_src_part) &&
    4806              :                            OidIsValid(event->ate_dst_part));
    4807          100 :                     src_rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate,
    4808              :                                                         event->ate_src_part,
    4809              :                                                         rInfo);
    4810          100 :                     dst_rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate,
    4811              :                                                         event->ate_dst_part,
    4812              :                                                         rInfo);
    4813              :                 }
    4814              :                 else
    4815       609534 :                     src_rInfo = dst_rInfo = rInfo;
    4816              : 
    4817              :                 /*
    4818              :                  * Fire it.  Note that the AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS flag is
    4819              :                  * still set, so recursive examinations of the event list
    4820              :                  * won't try to re-fire it.
    4821              :                  */
    4822       609634 :                 AfterTriggerExecute(estate, event, rInfo,
    4823              :                                     src_rInfo, dst_rInfo,
    4824              :                                     trigdesc, finfo, instr,
    4825              :                                     per_tuple_context, slot1, slot2);
    4826              : 
    4827              :                 /*
    4828              :                  * Mark the event as done.
    4829              :                  */
    4830       609020 :                 event->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    4831       609020 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    4832              :             }
    4833         1012 :             else if (!(event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE))
    4834              :             {
    4835              :                 /* something remains to be done */
    4836          352 :                 all_fired = all_fired_in_chunk = false;
    4837              :             }
    4838              :         }
    4839              : 
    4840              :         /* Clear the chunk if delete_ok and nothing left of interest */
    4841         4634 :         if (delete_ok && all_fired_in_chunk)
    4842              :         {
    4843          177 :             chunk->freeptr = CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    4844          177 :             chunk->endfree = chunk->endptr;
    4845              : 
    4846              :             /*
    4847              :              * If it's last chunk, must sync event list's tailfree too.  Note
    4848              :              * that delete_ok must NOT be passed as true if there could be
    4849              :              * additional AfterTriggerEventList values pointing at this event
    4850              :              * list, since we'd fail to fix their copies of tailfree.
    4851              :              */
    4852          177 :             if (chunk == events->tail)
    4853          177 :                 events->tailfree = chunk->freeptr;
    4854              :         }
    4855              :     }
    4856         4580 :     if (slot1 != NULL)
    4857              :     {
    4858           19 :         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot1);
    4859           19 :         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot2);
    4860              :     }
    4861              : 
    4862              :     /* Release working resources */
    4863         4580 :     MemoryContextDelete(per_tuple_context);
    4864              : 
    4865         4580 :     if (local_estate)
    4866              :     {
    4867          179 :         ExecCloseResultRelations(estate);
    4868          179 :         ExecResetTupleTable(estate->es_tupleTable, false);
    4869          179 :         FreeExecutorState(estate);
    4870              :     }
    4871              : 
    4872         4580 :     return all_fired;
    4873              : }
    4874              : 
    4875              : 
    4876              : /*
    4877              :  * GetAfterTriggersTableData
    4878              :  *
    4879              :  * Find or create an AfterTriggersTableData struct for the specified
    4880              :  * trigger event (relation + operation type).  Ignore existing structs
    4881              :  * marked "closed"; we don't want to put any additional tuples into them,
    4882              :  * nor change their stmt-triggers-fired state.
    4883              :  *
    4884              :  * Note: the AfterTriggersTableData list is allocated in the current
    4885              :  * (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext.  This is OK because
    4886              :  * we don't need it to live past AfterTriggerEndQuery.
    4887              :  */
    4888              : static AfterTriggersTableData *
    4889         1633 : GetAfterTriggersTableData(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    4890              : {
    4891              :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    4892              :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs;
    4893              :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4894              :     ListCell   *lc;
    4895              : 
    4896              :     /* At this level, cmdType should not be, eg, CMD_MERGE */
    4897              :     Assert(cmdType == CMD_INSERT ||
    4898              :            cmdType == CMD_UPDATE ||
    4899              :            cmdType == CMD_DELETE);
    4900              : 
    4901              :     /* Caller should have ensured query_depth is OK. */
    4902              :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= 0 &&
    4903              :            afterTriggers.query_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth);
    4904         1633 :     qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    4905              : 
    4906         1873 :     foreach(lc, qs->tables)
    4907              :     {
    4908         1084 :         table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    4909         1084 :         if (table->relid == relid && table->cmdType == cmdType &&
    4910          868 :             !table->closed)
    4911          844 :             return table;
    4912              :     }
    4913              : 
    4914          789 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4915              : 
    4916          789 :     table = palloc0_object(AfterTriggersTableData);
    4917          789 :     table->relid = relid;
    4918          789 :     table->cmdType = cmdType;
    4919          789 :     qs->tables = lappend(qs->tables, table);
    4920              : 
    4921          789 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4922              : 
    4923          789 :     return table;
    4924              : }
    4925              : 
    4926              : /*
    4927              :  * Returns a TupleTableSlot suitable for holding the tuples to be put
    4928              :  * into AfterTriggersTableData's transition table tuplestores.
    4929              :  */
    4930              : static TupleTableSlot *
    4931          196 : GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(AfterTriggersTableData *table,
    4932              :                           TupleDesc tupdesc)
    4933              : {
    4934              :     /* Create it if not already done. */
    4935          196 :     if (!table->storeslot)
    4936              :     {
    4937              :         MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4938              : 
    4939              :         /*
    4940              :          * We need this slot only until AfterTriggerEndQuery, but making it
    4941              :          * last till end-of-subxact is good enough.  It'll be freed by
    4942              :          * AfterTriggerFreeQuery().  However, the passed-in tupdesc might have
    4943              :          * a different lifespan, so we'd better make a copy of that.
    4944              :          */
    4945           56 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4946           56 :         tupdesc = CreateTupleDescCopy(tupdesc);
    4947           56 :         table->storeslot = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(tupdesc, &TTSOpsVirtual);
    4948           56 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4949              :     }
    4950              : 
    4951          196 :     return table->storeslot;
    4952              : }
    4953              : 
    4954              : /*
    4955              :  * MakeTransitionCaptureState
    4956              :  *
    4957              :  * Make a TransitionCaptureState object for the given TriggerDesc, target
    4958              :  * relation, and operation type.  The TCS object holds all the state needed
    4959              :  * to decide whether to capture tuples in transition tables.
    4960              :  *
    4961              :  * If there are no triggers in 'trigdesc' that request relevant transition
    4962              :  * tables, then return NULL.
    4963              :  *
    4964              :  * The resulting object can be passed to the ExecAR* functions.  When
    4965              :  * dealing with child tables, the caller can set tcs_original_insert_tuple
    4966              :  * to avoid having to reconstruct the original tuple in the root table's
    4967              :  * format.
    4968              :  *
    4969              :  * Note that we copy the flags from a parent table into this struct (rather
    4970              :  * than subsequently using the relation's TriggerDesc directly) so that we can
    4971              :  * use it to control collection of transition tuples from child tables.
    4972              :  *
    4973              :  * Per SQL spec, all operations of the same kind (INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE)
    4974              :  * on the same table during one query should share one transition table.
    4975              :  * Therefore, the Tuplestores are owned by an AfterTriggersTableData struct
    4976              :  * looked up using the table OID + CmdType, and are merely referenced by
    4977              :  * the TransitionCaptureState objects we hand out to callers.
    4978              :  */
    4979              : TransitionCaptureState *
    4980        75400 : MakeTransitionCaptureState(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    4981              : {
    4982              :     TransitionCaptureState *state;
    4983              :     bool        need_old_upd,
    4984              :                 need_new_upd,
    4985              :                 need_old_del,
    4986              :                 need_new_ins;
    4987              :     AfterTriggersTableData *ins_table;
    4988              :     AfterTriggersTableData *upd_table;
    4989              :     AfterTriggersTableData *del_table;
    4990              :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4991              :     ResourceOwner saveResourceOwner;
    4992              : 
    4993        75400 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    4994        66659 :         return NULL;
    4995              : 
    4996              :     /* Detect which table(s) we need. */
    4997         8741 :     switch (cmdType)
    4998              :     {
    4999         4920 :         case CMD_INSERT:
    5000         4920 :             need_old_upd = need_old_del = need_new_upd = false;
    5001         4920 :             need_new_ins = trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table;
    5002         4920 :             break;
    5003         2581 :         case CMD_UPDATE:
    5004         2581 :             need_old_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_old_table;
    5005         2581 :             need_new_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_new_table;
    5006         2581 :             need_old_del = need_new_ins = false;
    5007         2581 :             break;
    5008          994 :         case CMD_DELETE:
    5009          994 :             need_old_del = trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table;
    5010          994 :             need_old_upd = need_new_upd = need_new_ins = false;
    5011          994 :             break;
    5012          246 :         case CMD_MERGE:
    5013          246 :             need_old_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_old_table;
    5014          246 :             need_new_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_new_table;
    5015          246 :             need_old_del = trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table;
    5016          246 :             need_new_ins = trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table;
    5017          246 :             break;
    5018            0 :         default:
    5019            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unexpected CmdType: %d", (int) cmdType);
    5020              :             /* keep compiler quiet */
    5021              :             need_old_upd = need_new_upd = need_old_del = need_new_ins = false;
    5022              :             break;
    5023              :     }
    5024         8741 :     if (!need_old_upd && !need_new_upd && !need_new_ins && !need_old_del)
    5025         8310 :         return NULL;
    5026              : 
    5027              :     /* Check state, like AfterTriggerSaveEvent. */
    5028          431 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    5029            0 :         elog(ERROR, "MakeTransitionCaptureState() called outside of query");
    5030              : 
    5031              :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    5032          431 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5033          315 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    5034              : 
    5035              :     /*
    5036              :      * Find or create AfterTriggersTableData struct(s) to hold the
    5037              :      * tuplestore(s).  If there's a matching struct but it's marked closed,
    5038              :      * ignore it; we need a newer one.
    5039              :      *
    5040              :      * Note: MERGE must use the same AfterTriggersTableData structs as INSERT,
    5041              :      * UPDATE, and DELETE, so that any MERGE'd tuples are added to the same
    5042              :      * tuplestores as tuples from any INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE commands
    5043              :      * running in the same top-level command (e.g., in a writable CTE).
    5044              :      *
    5045              :      * Note: the AfterTriggersTableData list, as well as the tuplestores, are
    5046              :      * allocated in the current (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext, and
    5047              :      * the tuplestores are managed by the (sub)transaction's resource owner.
    5048              :      * This is sufficient lifespan because we do not allow triggers using
    5049              :      * transition tables to be deferrable; they will be fired during
    5050              :      * AfterTriggerEndQuery, after which it's okay to delete the data.
    5051              :      */
    5052          431 :     if (need_new_ins)
    5053          180 :         ins_table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, CMD_INSERT);
    5054              :     else
    5055          251 :         ins_table = NULL;
    5056              : 
    5057          431 :     if (need_old_upd || need_new_upd)
    5058          145 :         upd_table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, CMD_UPDATE);
    5059              :     else
    5060          286 :         upd_table = NULL;
    5061              : 
    5062          431 :     if (need_old_del)
    5063          130 :         del_table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, CMD_DELETE);
    5064              :     else
    5065          301 :         del_table = NULL;
    5066              : 
    5067              :     /* Now create required tuplestore(s), if we don't have them already. */
    5068          431 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    5069          431 :     saveResourceOwner = CurrentResourceOwner;
    5070          431 :     CurrentResourceOwner = CurTransactionResourceOwner;
    5071              : 
    5072          431 :     if (need_old_upd && upd_table->old_tuplestore == NULL)
    5073          121 :         upd_table->old_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    5074          431 :     if (need_new_upd && upd_table->new_tuplestore == NULL)
    5075          129 :         upd_table->new_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    5076          431 :     if (need_old_del && del_table->old_tuplestore == NULL)
    5077           98 :         del_table->old_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    5078          431 :     if (need_new_ins && ins_table->new_tuplestore == NULL)
    5079          172 :         ins_table->new_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    5080              : 
    5081          431 :     CurrentResourceOwner = saveResourceOwner;
    5082          431 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    5083              : 
    5084              :     /* Now build the TransitionCaptureState struct, in caller's context */
    5085          431 :     state = palloc0_object(TransitionCaptureState);
    5086          431 :     state->tcs_delete_old_table = need_old_del;
    5087          431 :     state->tcs_update_old_table = need_old_upd;
    5088          431 :     state->tcs_update_new_table = need_new_upd;
    5089          431 :     state->tcs_insert_new_table = need_new_ins;
    5090          431 :     state->tcs_insert_private = ins_table;
    5091          431 :     state->tcs_update_private = upd_table;
    5092          431 :     state->tcs_delete_private = del_table;
    5093              : 
    5094          431 :     return state;
    5095              : }
    5096              : 
    5097              : 
    5098              : /* ----------
    5099              :  * AfterTriggerBeginXact()
    5100              :  *
    5101              :  *  Called at transaction start (either BEGIN or implicit for single
    5102              :  *  statement outside of transaction block).
    5103              :  * ----------
    5104              :  */
    5105              : void
    5106       621791 : AfterTriggerBeginXact(void)
    5107              : {
    5108              :     /*
    5109              :      * Initialize after-trigger state structure to empty
    5110              :      */
    5111       621791 :     afterTriggers.firing_counter = (CommandId) 1;   /* mustn't be 0 */
    5112       621791 :     afterTriggers.query_depth = -1;
    5113       621791 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth = 0;
    5114       621791 :     afterTriggers.batch_callbacks = NIL;
    5115       621791 :     afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks = false;
    5116              : 
    5117              :     /*
    5118              :      * Verify that there is no leftover state remaining.  If these assertions
    5119              :      * trip, it means that AfterTriggerEndXact wasn't called or didn't clean
    5120              :      * up properly.
    5121              :      */
    5122              :     Assert(afterTriggers.state == NULL);
    5123              :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_stack == NULL);
    5124              :     Assert(afterTriggers.maxquerydepth == 0);
    5125              :     Assert(afterTriggers.event_cxt == NULL);
    5126              :     Assert(afterTriggers.events.head == NULL);
    5127              :     Assert(afterTriggers.trans_stack == NULL);
    5128              :     Assert(afterTriggers.maxtransdepth == 0);
    5129       621791 : }
    5130              : 
    5131              : 
    5132              : /* ----------
    5133              :  * AfterTriggerBeginQuery()
    5134              :  *
    5135              :  *  Called just before we start processing a single query within a
    5136              :  *  transaction (or subtransaction).  Most of the real work gets deferred
    5137              :  *  until somebody actually tries to queue a trigger event.
    5138              :  * ----------
    5139              :  */
    5140              : void
    5141       247580 : AfterTriggerBeginQuery(void)
    5142              : {
    5143              :     /* Increase the query stack depth */
    5144       247580 :     afterTriggers.query_depth++;
    5145       247580 : }
    5146              : 
    5147              : 
    5148              : /* ----------
    5149              :  * AfterTriggerEndQuery()
    5150              :  *
    5151              :  *  Called after one query has been completely processed. At this time
    5152              :  *  we invoke all AFTER IMMEDIATE trigger events queued by the query, and
    5153              :  *  transfer deferred trigger events to the global deferred-trigger list.
    5154              :  *
    5155              :  *  Note that this must be called BEFORE closing down the executor
    5156              :  *  with ExecutorEnd, because we make use of the EState's info about
    5157              :  *  target relations.  Normally it is called from ExecutorFinish.
    5158              :  * ----------
    5159              :  */
    5160              : void
    5161       244367 : AfterTriggerEndQuery(EState *estate)
    5162              : {
    5163              :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs;
    5164              : 
    5165              :     /* Must be inside a query, too */
    5166              :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= 0);
    5167              : 
    5168              :     /*
    5169              :      * If we never even got as far as initializing the event stack, there
    5170              :      * certainly won't be any events, so exit quickly.
    5171              :      */
    5172       244367 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5173              :     {
    5174       238376 :         afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5175       238376 :         return;
    5176              :     }
    5177              : 
    5178              :     /*
    5179              :      * Process all immediate-mode triggers queued by the query, and move the
    5180              :      * deferred ones to the main list of deferred events.
    5181              :      *
    5182              :      * Notice that we decide which ones will be fired, and put the deferred
    5183              :      * ones on the main list, before anything is actually fired.  This ensures
    5184              :      * reasonably sane behavior if a trigger function does SET CONSTRAINTS ...
    5185              :      * IMMEDIATE: all events we have decided to defer will be available for it
    5186              :      * to fire.
    5187              :      *
    5188              :      * We loop in case a trigger queues more events at the same query level.
    5189              :      * Ordinary trigger functions, including all PL/pgSQL trigger functions,
    5190              :      * will instead fire any triggers in a dedicated query level.  Foreign key
    5191              :      * enforcement triggers do add to the current query level, thanks to their
    5192              :      * passing fire_triggers = false to SPI_execute_snapshot().  Other
    5193              :      * C-language triggers might do likewise.
    5194              :      *
    5195              :      * If we find no firable events, we don't have to increment
    5196              :      * firing_counter.
    5197              :      */
    5198         5991 :     qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    5199              : 
    5200         5991 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth++;
    5201              :     for (;;)
    5202              :     {
    5203         6199 :         if (afterTriggerMarkEvents(&qs->events, &afterTriggers.events, true))
    5204              :         {
    5205         4942 :             CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    5206         4942 :             AfterTriggerEventChunk *oldtail = qs->events.tail;
    5207              : 
    5208         4942 :             if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(&qs->events, firing_id, estate, false))
    5209         4193 :                 break;          /* all fired */
    5210              : 
    5211              :             /*
    5212              :              * Firing a trigger could result in query_stack being repalloc'd,
    5213              :              * so we must recalculate qs after each afterTriggerInvokeEvents
    5214              :              * call.  Furthermore, it's unsafe to pass delete_ok = true here,
    5215              :              * because that could cause afterTriggerInvokeEvents to try to
    5216              :              * access qs->events after the stack has been repalloc'd.
    5217              :              */
    5218          208 :             qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    5219              : 
    5220              :             /*
    5221              :              * We'll need to scan the events list again.  To reduce the cost
    5222              :              * of doing so, get rid of completely-fired chunks.  We know that
    5223              :              * all events were marked IN_PROGRESS or DONE at the conclusion of
    5224              :              * afterTriggerMarkEvents, so any still-interesting events must
    5225              :              * have been added after that, and so must be in the chunk that
    5226              :              * was then the tail chunk, or in later chunks.  So, zap all
    5227              :              * chunks before oldtail.  This is approximately the same set of
    5228              :              * events we would have gotten rid of by passing delete_ok = true.
    5229              :              */
    5230              :             Assert(oldtail != NULL);
    5231          208 :             while (qs->events.head != oldtail)
    5232            0 :                 afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk(qs);
    5233              :         }
    5234              :         else
    5235         1249 :             break;
    5236              :     }
    5237              : 
    5238              :     /*
    5239              :      * Fire batch callbacks before releasing query-level storage and before
    5240              :      * decrementing query_depth.  Callbacks may do real work (index probes,
    5241              :      * error reporting).
    5242              :      */
    5243         5442 :     FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks(qs->batch_callbacks);
    5244              : 
    5245              :     /* Release query-level-local storage, including tuplestores if any */
    5246         5195 :     AfterTriggerFreeQuery(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth]);
    5247              : 
    5248         5195 :     afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5249         5195 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth--;
    5250              : }
    5251              : 
    5252              : 
    5253              : /*
    5254              :  * AfterTriggerFreeQuery
    5255              :  *  Release subsidiary storage for a trigger query level.
    5256              :  *  This includes closing down tuplestores.
    5257              :  *  Note: it's important for this to be safe if interrupted by an error
    5258              :  *  and then called again for the same query level.
    5259              :  */
    5260              : static void
    5261         5212 : AfterTriggerFreeQuery(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs)
    5262              : {
    5263              :     Tuplestorestate *ts;
    5264              :     List       *tables;
    5265              :     ListCell   *lc;
    5266              : 
    5267              :     /* Drop the trigger events */
    5268         5212 :     afterTriggerFreeEventList(&qs->events);
    5269              : 
    5270              :     /* Drop FDW tuplestore if any */
    5271         5212 :     ts = qs->fdw_tuplestore;
    5272         5212 :     qs->fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    5273         5212 :     if (ts)
    5274           18 :         tuplestore_end(ts);
    5275              : 
    5276              :     /* Release per-table subsidiary storage */
    5277         5212 :     tables = qs->tables;
    5278         5955 :     foreach(lc, tables)
    5279              :     {
    5280          743 :         AfterTriggersTableData *table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    5281              : 
    5282          743 :         ts = table->old_tuplestore;
    5283          743 :         table->old_tuplestore = NULL;
    5284          743 :         if (ts)
    5285          199 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5286          743 :         ts = table->new_tuplestore;
    5287          743 :         table->new_tuplestore = NULL;
    5288          743 :         if (ts)
    5289          275 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5290          743 :         if (table->storeslot)
    5291              :         {
    5292           56 :             TupleTableSlot *slot = table->storeslot;
    5293              : 
    5294           56 :             table->storeslot = NULL;
    5295           56 :             ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot);
    5296              :         }
    5297              :     }
    5298              : 
    5299              :     /*
    5300              :      * Now free the AfterTriggersTableData structs and list cells.  Reset list
    5301              :      * pointer first; if list_free_deep somehow gets an error, better to leak
    5302              :      * that storage than have an infinite loop.
    5303              :      */
    5304         5212 :     qs->tables = NIL;
    5305         5212 :     list_free_deep(tables);
    5306              : 
    5307         5212 :     list_free_deep(qs->batch_callbacks);
    5308         5212 :     qs->batch_callbacks = NIL;
    5309         5212 : }
    5310              : 
    5311              : 
    5312              : /* ----------
    5313              :  * AfterTriggerFireDeferred()
    5314              :  *
    5315              :  *  Called just before the current transaction is committed. At this
    5316              :  *  time we invoke all pending DEFERRED triggers.
    5317              :  *
    5318              :  *  It is possible for other modules to queue additional deferred triggers
    5319              :  *  during pre-commit processing; therefore xact.c may have to call this
    5320              :  *  multiple times.
    5321              :  * ----------
    5322              :  */
    5323              : void
    5324       592663 : AfterTriggerFireDeferred(void)
    5325              : {
    5326              :     AfterTriggerEventList *events;
    5327       592663 :     bool        snap_pushed = false;
    5328              : 
    5329              :     /* Must not be inside a query */
    5330              :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth == -1);
    5331              : 
    5332              :     /*
    5333              :      * If there are any triggers to fire, make sure we have set a snapshot for
    5334              :      * them to use.  (Since PortalRunUtility doesn't set a snap for COMMIT, we
    5335              :      * can't assume ActiveSnapshot is valid on entry.)
    5336              :      */
    5337       592663 :     events = &afterTriggers.events;
    5338       592663 :     if (events->head != NULL)
    5339              :     {
    5340          238 :         PushActiveSnapshot(GetTransactionSnapshot());
    5341          238 :         snap_pushed = true;
    5342              :     }
    5343              : 
    5344              :     /*
    5345              :      * Run all the remaining triggers.  Loop until they are all gone, in case
    5346              :      * some trigger queues more for us to do.
    5347              :      */
    5348       592663 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth++;
    5349       592663 :     while (afterTriggerMarkEvents(events, NULL, false))
    5350              :     {
    5351          238 :         CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    5352              : 
    5353          238 :         if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(events, firing_id, NULL, true))
    5354          169 :             break;              /* all fired */
    5355              :     }
    5356              : 
    5357              :     /* Flush any fast-path batches accumulated by the triggers just fired. */
    5358       592594 :     FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks(afterTriggers.batch_callbacks);
    5359              : 
    5360       592555 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth--;
    5361              : 
    5362              :     /*
    5363              :      * We don't bother freeing the event list or batch_callbacks, since they
    5364              :      * will go away anyway (and more efficiently than via pfree) in
    5365              :      * AfterTriggerEndXact.
    5366              :      */
    5367              : 
    5368       592555 :     if (snap_pushed)
    5369          130 :         PopActiveSnapshot();
    5370       592555 : }
    5371              : 
    5372              : 
    5373              : /* ----------
    5374              :  * AfterTriggerEndXact()
    5375              :  *
    5376              :  *  The current transaction is finishing.
    5377              :  *
    5378              :  *  Any unfired triggers are canceled so we simply throw
    5379              :  *  away anything we know.
    5380              :  *
    5381              :  *  Note: it is possible for this to be called repeatedly in case of
    5382              :  *  error during transaction abort; therefore, do not complain if
    5383              :  *  already closed down.
    5384              :  * ----------
    5385              :  */
    5386              : void
    5387       622016 : AfterTriggerEndXact(bool isCommit)
    5388              : {
    5389              :     /*
    5390              :      * Forget the pending-events list.
    5391              :      *
    5392              :      * Since all the info is in TopTransactionContext or children thereof, we
    5393              :      * don't really need to do anything to reclaim memory.  However, the
    5394              :      * pending-events list could be large, and so it's useful to discard it as
    5395              :      * soon as possible --- especially if we are aborting because we ran out
    5396              :      * of memory for the list!
    5397              :      */
    5398       622016 :     if (afterTriggers.event_cxt)
    5399              :     {
    5400         4475 :         MemoryContextDelete(afterTriggers.event_cxt);
    5401         4475 :         afterTriggers.event_cxt = NULL;
    5402         4475 :         afterTriggers.events.head = NULL;
    5403         4475 :         afterTriggers.events.tail = NULL;
    5404         4475 :         afterTriggers.events.tailfree = NULL;
    5405              :     }
    5406              : 
    5407              :     /*
    5408              :      * Forget any subtransaction state as well.  Since this can't be very
    5409              :      * large, we let the eventual reset of TopTransactionContext free the
    5410              :      * memory instead of doing it here.
    5411              :      */
    5412       622016 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack = NULL;
    5413       622016 :     afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = 0;
    5414              : 
    5415              : 
    5416              :     /*
    5417              :      * Forget the query stack and constraint-related state information.  As
    5418              :      * with the subtransaction state information, we don't bother freeing the
    5419              :      * memory here.
    5420              :      */
    5421       622016 :     afterTriggers.query_stack = NULL;
    5422       622016 :     afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = 0;
    5423       622016 :     afterTriggers.state = NULL;
    5424              : 
    5425              :     /* No more afterTriggers manipulation until next transaction starts. */
    5426       622016 :     afterTriggers.query_depth = -1;
    5427              : 
    5428       622016 :     afterTriggers.firing_depth = 0;
    5429              : 
    5430       622016 :     list_free_deep(afterTriggers.batch_callbacks);
    5431       622016 :     afterTriggers.batch_callbacks = NIL;
    5432       622016 :     afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks = false;
    5433       622016 : }
    5434              : 
    5435              : /*
    5436              :  * AfterTriggerBeginSubXact()
    5437              :  *
    5438              :  *  Start a subtransaction.
    5439              :  */
    5440              : void
    5441        11037 : AfterTriggerBeginSubXact(void)
    5442              : {
    5443        11037 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5444              : 
    5445              :     /*
    5446              :      * Allocate more space in the trans_stack if needed.  (Note: because the
    5447              :      * minimum nest level of a subtransaction is 2, we waste the first couple
    5448              :      * entries of the array; not worth the notational effort to avoid it.)
    5449              :      */
    5450        12564 :     while (my_level >= afterTriggers.maxtransdepth)
    5451              :     {
    5452         1527 :         if (afterTriggers.maxtransdepth == 0)
    5453              :         {
    5454              :             /* Arbitrarily initialize for max of 8 subtransaction levels */
    5455         1483 :             afterTriggers.trans_stack = (AfterTriggersTransData *)
    5456         1483 :                 MemoryContextAlloc(TopTransactionContext,
    5457              :                                    8 * sizeof(AfterTriggersTransData));
    5458         1483 :             afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = 8;
    5459              :         }
    5460              :         else
    5461              :         {
    5462              :             /* repalloc will keep the stack in the same context */
    5463           44 :             int         new_alloc = afterTriggers.maxtransdepth * 2;
    5464              : 
    5465           44 :             afterTriggers.trans_stack = (AfterTriggersTransData *)
    5466           44 :                 repalloc(afterTriggers.trans_stack,
    5467              :                          new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersTransData));
    5468           44 :             afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = new_alloc;
    5469              :         }
    5470              :     }
    5471              : 
    5472              :     /*
    5473              :      * Push the current information into the stack.  The SET CONSTRAINTS state
    5474              :      * is not saved until/unless changed.  Likewise, we don't make a
    5475              :      * per-subtransaction event context until needed.
    5476              :      */
    5477        11037 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5478        11037 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].events = afterTriggers.events;
    5479        11037 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth = afterTriggers.query_depth;
    5480        11037 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].firing_counter = afterTriggers.firing_counter;
    5481        11037 : }
    5482              : 
    5483              : /*
    5484              :  * AfterTriggerEndSubXact()
    5485              :  *
    5486              :  *  The current subtransaction is ending.
    5487              :  */
    5488              : void
    5489        11037 : AfterTriggerEndSubXact(bool isCommit)
    5490              : {
    5491        11037 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5492              :     SetConstraintState state;
    5493              :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    5494              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    5495              :     CommandId   subxact_firing_id;
    5496              : 
    5497              :     /*
    5498              :      * Pop the prior state if needed.
    5499              :      */
    5500        11037 :     if (isCommit)
    5501              :     {
    5502              :         Assert(my_level < afterTriggers.maxtransdepth);
    5503              :         /* If we saved a prior state, we don't need it anymore */
    5504         5641 :         state = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state;
    5505         5641 :         if (state != NULL)
    5506            4 :             pfree(state);
    5507              :         /* this avoids double pfree if error later: */
    5508         5641 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5509              :         Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth ==
    5510              :                afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth);
    5511              :     }
    5512              :     else
    5513              :     {
    5514              :         /*
    5515              :          * Aborting.  It is possible subxact start failed before calling
    5516              :          * AfterTriggerBeginSubXact, in which case we mustn't risk touching
    5517              :          * trans_stack levels that aren't there.
    5518              :          */
    5519         5396 :         if (my_level >= afterTriggers.maxtransdepth)
    5520            0 :             return;
    5521              : 
    5522              :         /*
    5523              :          * Release query-level storage for queries being aborted, and restore
    5524              :          * query_depth to its pre-subxact value.  This assumes that a
    5525              :          * subtransaction will not add events to query levels started in a
    5526              :          * earlier transaction state.
    5527              :          */
    5528         5453 :         while (afterTriggers.query_depth > afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth)
    5529              :         {
    5530           57 :             if (afterTriggers.query_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5531           17 :                 AfterTriggerFreeQuery(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth]);
    5532           57 :             afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5533              :         }
    5534              :         Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth ==
    5535              :                afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth);
    5536              : 
    5537              :         /*
    5538              :          * Restore the global deferred-event list to its former length,
    5539              :          * discarding any events queued by the subxact.
    5540              :          */
    5541         5396 :         afterTriggerRestoreEventList(&afterTriggers.events,
    5542         5396 :                                      &afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].events);
    5543              : 
    5544              :         /*
    5545              :          * Restore the trigger state.  If the saved state is NULL, then this
    5546              :          * subxact didn't save it, so it doesn't need restoring.
    5547              :          */
    5548         5396 :         state = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state;
    5549         5396 :         if (state != NULL)
    5550              :         {
    5551            2 :             pfree(afterTriggers.state);
    5552            2 :             afterTriggers.state = state;
    5553              :         }
    5554              :         /* this avoids double pfree if error later: */
    5555         5396 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5556              : 
    5557              :         /*
    5558              :          * Scan for any remaining deferred events that were marked DONE or IN
    5559              :          * PROGRESS by this subxact or a child, and un-mark them. We can
    5560              :          * recognize such events because they have a firing ID greater than or
    5561              :          * equal to the firing_counter value we saved at subtransaction start.
    5562              :          * (This essentially assumes that the current subxact includes all
    5563              :          * subxacts started after it.)
    5564              :          */
    5565         5396 :         subxact_firing_id = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].firing_counter;
    5566         5424 :         for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.events)
    5567              :         {
    5568           14 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    5569              : 
    5570           14 :             if (event->ate_flags &
    5571              :                 (AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS))
    5572              :             {
    5573            2 :                 if (evtshared->ats_firing_id >= subxact_firing_id)
    5574            2 :                     event->ate_flags &=
    5575              :                         ~(AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS);
    5576              :             }
    5577              :         }
    5578              :     }
    5579              : 
    5580              :     /* Reset in case a callback threw an error while firing. */
    5581        11037 :     afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks = false;
    5582              : }
    5583              : 
    5584              : /*
    5585              :  * Get the transition table for the given event and depending on whether we are
    5586              :  * processing the old or the new tuple.
    5587              :  */
    5588              : static Tuplestorestate *
    5589        44126 : GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(int event,
    5590              :                                 TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    5591              :                                 TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    5592              :                                 TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    5593              : {
    5594        44126 :     Tuplestorestate *tuplestore = NULL;
    5595        44126 :     bool        delete_old_table = transition_capture->tcs_delete_old_table;
    5596        44126 :     bool        update_old_table = transition_capture->tcs_update_old_table;
    5597        44126 :     bool        update_new_table = transition_capture->tcs_update_new_table;
    5598        44126 :     bool        insert_new_table = transition_capture->tcs_insert_new_table;
    5599              : 
    5600              :     /*
    5601              :      * For INSERT events NEW should be non-NULL, for DELETE events OLD should
    5602              :      * be non-NULL, whereas for UPDATE events normally both OLD and NEW are
    5603              :      * non-NULL.  But for UPDATE events fired for capturing transition tuples
    5604              :      * during UPDATE partition-key row movement, OLD is NULL when the event is
    5605              :      * for a row being inserted, whereas NEW is NULL when the event is for a
    5606              :      * row being deleted.
    5607              :      */
    5608              :     Assert(!(event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && delete_old_table &&
    5609              :              TupIsNull(oldslot)));
    5610              :     Assert(!(event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && insert_new_table &&
    5611              :              TupIsNull(newslot)));
    5612              : 
    5613        44126 :     if (!TupIsNull(oldslot))
    5614              :     {
    5615              :         Assert(TupIsNull(newslot));
    5616         3619 :         if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && delete_old_table)
    5617         3372 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_delete_private->old_tuplestore;
    5618          247 :         else if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && update_old_table)
    5619          231 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_update_private->old_tuplestore;
    5620              :     }
    5621        40507 :     else if (!TupIsNull(newslot))
    5622              :     {
    5623              :         Assert(TupIsNull(oldslot));
    5624        40507 :         if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && insert_new_table)
    5625        40260 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_insert_private->new_tuplestore;
    5626          247 :         else if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && update_new_table)
    5627          243 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_update_private->new_tuplestore;
    5628              :     }
    5629              : 
    5630        44126 :     return tuplestore;
    5631              : }
    5632              : 
    5633              : /*
    5634              :  * Add the given heap tuple to the given tuplestore, applying the conversion
    5635              :  * map if necessary.
    5636              :  *
    5637              :  * If original_insert_tuple is given, we can add that tuple without conversion.
    5638              :  */
    5639              : static void
    5640        44126 : TransitionTableAddTuple(EState *estate,
    5641              :                         int event,
    5642              :                         TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    5643              :                         ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    5644              :                         TupleTableSlot *slot,
    5645              :                         TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple,
    5646              :                         Tuplestorestate *tuplestore)
    5647              : {
    5648              :     TupleConversionMap *map;
    5649              : 
    5650              :     /*
    5651              :      * Nothing needs to be done if we don't have a tuplestore.
    5652              :      */
    5653        44126 :     if (tuplestore == NULL)
    5654           20 :         return;
    5655              : 
    5656        44106 :     if (original_insert_tuple)
    5657           96 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, original_insert_tuple);
    5658        44010 :     else if ((map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(relinfo)) != NULL)
    5659              :     {
    5660              :         AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    5661              :         TupleTableSlot *storeslot;
    5662              : 
    5663          196 :         switch (event)
    5664              :         {
    5665            8 :             case TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT:
    5666            8 :                 table = transition_capture->tcs_insert_private;
    5667            8 :                 break;
    5668          164 :             case TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE:
    5669          164 :                 table = transition_capture->tcs_update_private;
    5670          164 :                 break;
    5671           24 :             case TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE:
    5672           24 :                 table = transition_capture->tcs_delete_private;
    5673           24 :                 break;
    5674            0 :             default:
    5675            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "invalid after-trigger event code: %d", event);
    5676              :                 table = NULL;   /* keep compiler quiet */
    5677              :                 break;
    5678              :         }
    5679              : 
    5680          196 :         storeslot = GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(table, map->outdesc);
    5681          196 :         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap, slot, storeslot);
    5682          196 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, storeslot);
    5683              :     }
    5684              :     else
    5685        43814 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, slot);
    5686              : }
    5687              : 
    5688              : /* ----------
    5689              :  * AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState()
    5690              :  *
    5691              :  *  Prepare the necessary state so that we can record AFTER trigger events
    5692              :  *  queued by a query.  It is allowed to have nested queries within a
    5693              :  *  (sub)transaction, so we need to have separate state for each query
    5694              :  *  nesting level.
    5695              :  * ----------
    5696              :  */
    5697              : static void
    5698         4708 : AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState(void)
    5699              : {
    5700         4708 :     int         init_depth = afterTriggers.maxquerydepth;
    5701              : 
    5702              :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth);
    5703              : 
    5704         4708 :     if (afterTriggers.maxquerydepth == 0)
    5705              :     {
    5706         4708 :         int         new_alloc = Max(afterTriggers.query_depth + 1, 8);
    5707              : 
    5708         4708 :         afterTriggers.query_stack = (AfterTriggersQueryData *)
    5709         4708 :             MemoryContextAlloc(TopTransactionContext,
    5710              :                                new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersQueryData));
    5711         4708 :         afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = new_alloc;
    5712              :     }
    5713              :     else
    5714              :     {
    5715              :         /* repalloc will keep the stack in the same context */
    5716            0 :         int         old_alloc = afterTriggers.maxquerydepth;
    5717            0 :         int         new_alloc = Max(afterTriggers.query_depth + 1,
    5718              :                                     old_alloc * 2);
    5719              : 
    5720            0 :         afterTriggers.query_stack = (AfterTriggersQueryData *)
    5721            0 :             repalloc(afterTriggers.query_stack,
    5722              :                      new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersQueryData));
    5723            0 :         afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = new_alloc;
    5724              :     }
    5725              : 
    5726              :     /* Initialize new array entries to empty */
    5727        42372 :     while (init_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5728              :     {
    5729        37664 :         AfterTriggersQueryData *qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[init_depth];
    5730              : 
    5731        37664 :         qs->events.head = NULL;
    5732        37664 :         qs->events.tail = NULL;
    5733        37664 :         qs->events.tailfree = NULL;
    5734        37664 :         qs->fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    5735        37664 :         qs->tables = NIL;
    5736        37664 :         qs->batch_callbacks = NIL;
    5737              : 
    5738        37664 :         ++init_depth;
    5739              :     }
    5740         4708 : }
    5741              : 
    5742              : /*
    5743              :  * Create an empty SetConstraintState with room for numalloc trigstates
    5744              :  */
    5745              : static SetConstraintState
    5746           67 : SetConstraintStateCreate(int numalloc)
    5747              : {
    5748              :     SetConstraintState state;
    5749              : 
    5750              :     /* Behave sanely with numalloc == 0 */
    5751           67 :     if (numalloc <= 0)
    5752            6 :         numalloc = 1;
    5753              : 
    5754              :     /*
    5755              :      * We assume that zeroing will correctly initialize the state values.
    5756              :      */
    5757              :     state = (SetConstraintState)
    5758           67 :         MemoryContextAllocZero(TopTransactionContext,
    5759              :                                offsetof(SetConstraintStateData, trigstates) +
    5760           67 :                                numalloc * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5761              : 
    5762           67 :     state->numalloc = numalloc;
    5763              : 
    5764           67 :     return state;
    5765              : }
    5766              : 
    5767              : /*
    5768              :  * Copy a SetConstraintState
    5769              :  */
    5770              : static SetConstraintState
    5771            6 : SetConstraintStateCopy(SetConstraintState origstate)
    5772              : {
    5773              :     SetConstraintState state;
    5774              : 
    5775            6 :     state = SetConstraintStateCreate(origstate->numstates);
    5776              : 
    5777            6 :     state->all_isset = origstate->all_isset;
    5778            6 :     state->all_isdeferred = origstate->all_isdeferred;
    5779            6 :     state->numstates = origstate->numstates;
    5780            6 :     memcpy(state->trigstates, origstate->trigstates,
    5781            6 :            origstate->numstates * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5782              : 
    5783            6 :     return state;
    5784              : }
    5785              : 
    5786              : /*
    5787              :  * Add a per-trigger item to a SetConstraintState.  Returns possibly-changed
    5788              :  * pointer to the state object (it will change if we have to repalloc).
    5789              :  */
    5790              : static SetConstraintState
    5791          228 : SetConstraintStateAddItem(SetConstraintState state,
    5792              :                           Oid tgoid, bool tgisdeferred)
    5793              : {
    5794          228 :     if (state->numstates >= state->numalloc)
    5795              :     {
    5796           20 :         int         newalloc = state->numalloc * 2;
    5797              : 
    5798           20 :         newalloc = Max(newalloc, 8);    /* in case original has size 0 */
    5799              :         state = (SetConstraintState)
    5800           20 :             repalloc(state,
    5801              :                      offsetof(SetConstraintStateData, trigstates) +
    5802           20 :                      newalloc * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5803           20 :         state->numalloc = newalloc;
    5804              :         Assert(state->numstates < state->numalloc);
    5805              :     }
    5806              : 
    5807          228 :     state->trigstates[state->numstates].sct_tgoid = tgoid;
    5808          228 :     state->trigstates[state->numstates].sct_tgisdeferred = tgisdeferred;
    5809          228 :     state->numstates++;
    5810              : 
    5811          228 :     return state;
    5812              : }
    5813              : 
    5814              : /* ----------
    5815              :  * AfterTriggerSetState()
    5816              :  *
    5817              :  *  Execute the SET CONSTRAINTS ... utility command.
    5818              :  * ----------
    5819              :  */
    5820              : void
    5821           71 : AfterTriggerSetState(ConstraintsSetStmt *stmt)
    5822              : {
    5823           71 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5824              : 
    5825              :     /* If we haven't already done so, initialize our state. */
    5826           71 :     if (afterTriggers.state == NULL)
    5827           61 :         afterTriggers.state = SetConstraintStateCreate(8);
    5828              : 
    5829              :     /*
    5830              :      * If in a subtransaction, and we didn't save the current state already,
    5831              :      * save it so it can be restored if the subtransaction aborts.
    5832              :      */
    5833           71 :     if (my_level > 1 &&
    5834            6 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state == NULL)
    5835              :     {
    5836            6 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state =
    5837            6 :             SetConstraintStateCopy(afterTriggers.state);
    5838              :     }
    5839              : 
    5840              :     /*
    5841              :      * Handle SET CONSTRAINTS ALL ...
    5842              :      */
    5843           71 :     if (stmt->constraints == NIL)
    5844              :     {
    5845              :         /*
    5846              :          * Forget any previous SET CONSTRAINTS commands in this transaction.
    5847              :          */
    5848           39 :         afterTriggers.state->numstates = 0;
    5849              : 
    5850              :         /*
    5851              :          * Set the per-transaction ALL state to known.
    5852              :          */
    5853           39 :         afterTriggers.state->all_isset = true;
    5854           39 :         afterTriggers.state->all_isdeferred = stmt->deferred;
    5855              :     }
    5856              :     else
    5857              :     {
    5858              :         Relation    conrel;
    5859              :         Relation    tgrel;
    5860           32 :         List       *conoidlist = NIL;
    5861           32 :         List       *tgoidlist = NIL;
    5862              :         ListCell   *lc;
    5863              : 
    5864              :         /*
    5865              :          * Handle SET CONSTRAINTS constraint-name [, ...]
    5866              :          *
    5867              :          * First, identify all the named constraints and make a list of their
    5868              :          * OIDs.  Since, unlike the SQL spec, we allow multiple constraints of
    5869              :          * the same name within a schema, the specifications are not
    5870              :          * necessarily unique.  Our strategy is to target all matching
    5871              :          * constraints within the first search-path schema that has any
    5872              :          * matches, but disregard matches in schemas beyond the first match.
    5873              :          * (This is a bit odd but it's the historical behavior.)
    5874              :          *
    5875              :          * A constraint in a partitioned table may have corresponding
    5876              :          * constraints in the partitions.  Grab those too.
    5877              :          */
    5878           32 :         conrel = table_open(ConstraintRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    5879              : 
    5880           64 :         foreach(lc, stmt->constraints)
    5881              :         {
    5882           32 :             RangeVar   *constraint = lfirst(lc);
    5883              :             bool        found;
    5884              :             List       *namespacelist;
    5885              :             ListCell   *nslc;
    5886              : 
    5887           32 :             if (constraint->catalogname)
    5888              :             {
    5889            0 :                 if (strcmp(constraint->catalogname, get_database_name(MyDatabaseId)) != 0)
    5890            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    5891              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    5892              :                              errmsg("cross-database references are not implemented: \"%s.%s.%s\"",
    5893              :                                     constraint->catalogname, constraint->schemaname,
    5894              :                                     constraint->relname)));
    5895              :             }
    5896              : 
    5897              :             /*
    5898              :              * If we're given the schema name with the constraint, look only
    5899              :              * in that schema.  If given a bare constraint name, use the
    5900              :              * search path to find the first matching constraint.
    5901              :              */
    5902           32 :             if (constraint->schemaname)
    5903              :             {
    5904            8 :                 Oid         namespaceId = LookupExplicitNamespace(constraint->schemaname,
    5905              :                                                                   false);
    5906              : 
    5907            8 :                 namespacelist = list_make1_oid(namespaceId);
    5908              :             }
    5909              :             else
    5910              :             {
    5911           24 :                 namespacelist = fetch_search_path(true);
    5912              :             }
    5913              : 
    5914           32 :             found = false;
    5915           80 :             foreach(nslc, namespacelist)
    5916              :             {
    5917           80 :                 Oid         namespaceId = lfirst_oid(nslc);
    5918              :                 SysScanDesc conscan;
    5919              :                 ScanKeyData skey[2];
    5920              :                 HeapTuple   tup;
    5921              : 
    5922           80 :                 ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    5923              :                             Anum_pg_constraint_conname,
    5924              :                             BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    5925           80 :                             CStringGetDatum(constraint->relname));
    5926           80 :                 ScanKeyInit(&skey[1],
    5927              :                             Anum_pg_constraint_connamespace,
    5928              :                             BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    5929              :                             ObjectIdGetDatum(namespaceId));
    5930              : 
    5931           80 :                 conscan = systable_beginscan(conrel, ConstraintNameNspIndexId,
    5932              :                                              true, NULL, 2, skey);
    5933              : 
    5934          144 :                 while (HeapTupleIsValid(tup = systable_getnext(conscan)))
    5935              :                 {
    5936           64 :                     Form_pg_constraint con = (Form_pg_constraint) GETSTRUCT(tup);
    5937              : 
    5938           64 :                     if (con->condeferrable)
    5939           64 :                         conoidlist = lappend_oid(conoidlist, con->oid);
    5940            0 :                     else if (stmt->deferred)
    5941            0 :                         ereport(ERROR,
    5942              :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    5943              :                                  errmsg("constraint \"%s\" is not deferrable",
    5944              :                                         constraint->relname)));
    5945           64 :                     found = true;
    5946              :                 }
    5947              : 
    5948           80 :                 systable_endscan(conscan);
    5949              : 
    5950              :                 /*
    5951              :                  * Once we've found a matching constraint we do not search
    5952              :                  * later parts of the search path.
    5953              :                  */
    5954           80 :                 if (found)
    5955           32 :                     break;
    5956              :             }
    5957              : 
    5958           32 :             list_free(namespacelist);
    5959              : 
    5960              :             /*
    5961              :              * Not found ?
    5962              :              */
    5963           32 :             if (!found)
    5964            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    5965              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    5966              :                          errmsg("constraint \"%s\" does not exist",
    5967              :                                 constraint->relname)));
    5968              :         }
    5969              : 
    5970              :         /*
    5971              :          * Scan for any possible descendants of the constraints.  We append
    5972              :          * whatever we find to the same list that we're scanning; this has the
    5973              :          * effect that we create new scans for those, too, so if there are
    5974              :          * further descendents, we'll also catch them.
    5975              :          */
    5976          172 :         foreach(lc, conoidlist)
    5977              :         {
    5978          140 :             Oid         parent = lfirst_oid(lc);
    5979              :             ScanKeyData key;
    5980              :             SysScanDesc scan;
    5981              :             HeapTuple   tuple;
    5982              : 
    5983          140 :             ScanKeyInit(&key,
    5984              :                         Anum_pg_constraint_conparentid,
    5985              :                         BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    5986              :                         ObjectIdGetDatum(parent));
    5987              : 
    5988          140 :             scan = systable_beginscan(conrel, ConstraintParentIndexId, true, NULL, 1, &key);
    5989              : 
    5990          216 :             while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(scan)))
    5991              :             {
    5992           76 :                 Form_pg_constraint con = (Form_pg_constraint) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    5993              : 
    5994           76 :                 conoidlist = lappend_oid(conoidlist, con->oid);
    5995              :             }
    5996              : 
    5997          140 :             systable_endscan(scan);
    5998              :         }
    5999              : 
    6000           32 :         table_close(conrel, AccessShareLock);
    6001              : 
    6002              :         /*
    6003              :          * Now, locate the trigger(s) implementing each of these constraints,
    6004              :          * and make a list of their OIDs.
    6005              :          */
    6006           32 :         tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    6007              : 
    6008          172 :         foreach(lc, conoidlist)
    6009              :         {
    6010          140 :             Oid         conoid = lfirst_oid(lc);
    6011              :             ScanKeyData skey;
    6012              :             SysScanDesc tgscan;
    6013              :             HeapTuple   htup;
    6014              : 
    6015          140 :             ScanKeyInit(&skey,
    6016              :                         Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstraint,
    6017              :                         BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    6018              :                         ObjectIdGetDatum(conoid));
    6019              : 
    6020          140 :             tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerConstraintIndexId, true,
    6021              :                                         NULL, 1, &skey);
    6022              : 
    6023          572 :             while (HeapTupleIsValid(htup = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    6024              :             {
    6025          292 :                 Form_pg_trigger pg_trigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(htup);
    6026              : 
    6027              :                 /*
    6028              :                  * Silently skip triggers that are marked as non-deferrable in
    6029              :                  * pg_trigger.  This is not an error condition, since a
    6030              :                  * deferrable RI constraint may have some non-deferrable
    6031              :                  * actions.
    6032              :                  */
    6033          292 :                 if (pg_trigger->tgdeferrable)
    6034          292 :                     tgoidlist = lappend_oid(tgoidlist, pg_trigger->oid);
    6035              :             }
    6036              : 
    6037          140 :             systable_endscan(tgscan);
    6038              :         }
    6039              : 
    6040           32 :         table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    6041              : 
    6042              :         /*
    6043              :          * Now we can set the trigger states of individual triggers for this
    6044              :          * xact.
    6045              :          */
    6046          324 :         foreach(lc, tgoidlist)
    6047              :         {
    6048          292 :             Oid         tgoid = lfirst_oid(lc);
    6049          292 :             SetConstraintState state = afterTriggers.state;
    6050          292 :             bool        found = false;
    6051              :             int         i;
    6052              : 
    6053         1632 :             for (i = 0; i < state->numstates; i++)
    6054              :             {
    6055         1404 :                 if (state->trigstates[i].sct_tgoid == tgoid)
    6056              :                 {
    6057           64 :                     state->trigstates[i].sct_tgisdeferred = stmt->deferred;
    6058           64 :                     found = true;
    6059           64 :                     break;
    6060              :                 }
    6061              :             }
    6062          292 :             if (!found)
    6063              :             {
    6064          228 :                 afterTriggers.state =
    6065          228 :                     SetConstraintStateAddItem(state, tgoid, stmt->deferred);
    6066              :             }
    6067              :         }
    6068              :     }
    6069              : 
    6070              :     /*
    6071              :      * SQL99 requires that when a constraint is set to IMMEDIATE, any deferred
    6072              :      * checks against that constraint must be made when the SET CONSTRAINTS
    6073              :      * command is executed -- i.e. the effects of the SET CONSTRAINTS command
    6074              :      * apply retroactively.  We've updated the constraints state, so scan the
    6075              :      * list of previously deferred events to fire any that have now become
    6076              :      * immediate.
    6077              :      *
    6078              :      * Obviously, if this was SET ... DEFERRED then it can't have converted
    6079              :      * any unfired events to immediate, so we need do nothing in that case.
    6080              :      */
    6081           71 :     if (!stmt->deferred)
    6082              :     {
    6083           26 :         AfterTriggerEventList *events = &afterTriggers.events;
    6084           26 :         bool        snapshot_set = false;
    6085              : 
    6086           26 :         afterTriggers.firing_depth++;
    6087           26 :         while (afterTriggerMarkEvents(events, NULL, true))
    6088              :         {
    6089           14 :             CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    6090              : 
    6091              :             /*
    6092              :              * Make sure a snapshot has been established in case trigger
    6093              :              * functions need one.  Note that we avoid setting a snapshot if
    6094              :              * we don't find at least one trigger that has to be fired now.
    6095              :              * This is so that BEGIN; SET CONSTRAINTS ...; SET TRANSACTION
    6096              :              * ISOLATION LEVEL SERIALIZABLE; ... works properly.  (If we are
    6097              :              * at the start of a transaction it's not possible for any trigger
    6098              :              * events to be queued yet.)
    6099              :              */
    6100           14 :             if (!snapshot_set)
    6101              :             {
    6102           14 :                 PushActiveSnapshot(GetTransactionSnapshot());
    6103           14 :                 snapshot_set = true;
    6104              :             }
    6105              : 
    6106              :             /*
    6107              :              * We can delete fired events if we are at top transaction level,
    6108              :              * but we'd better not if inside a subtransaction, since the
    6109              :              * subtransaction could later get rolled back.
    6110              :              */
    6111           10 :             if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(events, firing_id, NULL,
    6112           14 :                                          !IsSubTransaction()))
    6113           10 :                 break;          /* all fired */
    6114              :         }
    6115              : 
    6116              :         /*
    6117              :          * Flush any fast-path batches accumulated by the triggers just fired.
    6118              :          */
    6119           22 :         FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks(afterTriggers.batch_callbacks);
    6120           16 :         afterTriggers.firing_depth--;
    6121           16 :         list_free_deep(afterTriggers.batch_callbacks);
    6122           16 :         afterTriggers.batch_callbacks = NIL;
    6123              : 
    6124           16 :         if (snapshot_set)
    6125            4 :             PopActiveSnapshot();
    6126              :     }
    6127           61 : }
    6128              : 
    6129              : /* ----------
    6130              :  * AfterTriggerPendingOnRel()
    6131              :  *      Test to see if there are any pending after-trigger events for rel.
    6132              :  *
    6133              :  * This is used by TRUNCATE, CLUSTER, ALTER TABLE, etc to detect whether
    6134              :  * it is unsafe to perform major surgery on a relation.  Note that only
    6135              :  * local pending events are examined.  We assume that having exclusive lock
    6136              :  * on a rel guarantees there are no unserviced events in other backends ---
    6137              :  * but having a lock does not prevent there being such events in our own.
    6138              :  *
    6139              :  * In some scenarios it'd be reasonable to remove pending events (more
    6140              :  * specifically, mark them DONE by the current subxact) but without a lot
    6141              :  * of knowledge of the trigger semantics we can't do this in general.
    6142              :  * ----------
    6143              :  */
    6144              : bool
    6145        93156 : AfterTriggerPendingOnRel(Oid relid)
    6146              : {
    6147              :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    6148              :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    6149              :     int         depth;
    6150              : 
    6151              :     /* Scan queued events */
    6152        93180 :     for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.events)
    6153              :     {
    6154           24 :         AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    6155              : 
    6156              :         /*
    6157              :          * We can ignore completed events.  (Even if a DONE flag is rolled
    6158              :          * back by subxact abort, it's OK because the effects of the TRUNCATE
    6159              :          * or whatever must get rolled back too.)
    6160              :          */
    6161           24 :         if (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE)
    6162            0 :             continue;
    6163              : 
    6164           24 :         if (evtshared->ats_relid == relid)
    6165           12 :             return true;
    6166              :     }
    6167              : 
    6168              :     /*
    6169              :      * Also scan events queued by incomplete queries.  This could only matter
    6170              :      * if TRUNCATE/etc is executed by a function or trigger within an updating
    6171              :      * query on the same relation, which is pretty perverse, but let's check.
    6172              :      */
    6173        93144 :     for (depth = 0; depth <= afterTriggers.query_depth && depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth; depth++)
    6174              :     {
    6175            0 :         for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.query_stack[depth].events)
    6176              :         {
    6177            0 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    6178              : 
    6179            0 :             if (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE)
    6180            0 :                 continue;
    6181              : 
    6182            0 :             if (evtshared->ats_relid == relid)
    6183            0 :                 return true;
    6184              :         }
    6185              :     }
    6186              : 
    6187        93144 :     return false;
    6188              : }
    6189              : 
    6190              : /* ----------
    6191              :  * AfterTriggerSaveEvent()
    6192              :  *
    6193              :  *  Called by ExecA[RS]...Triggers() to queue up the triggers that should
    6194              :  *  be fired for an event.
    6195              :  *
    6196              :  *  NOTE: this is called whenever there are any triggers associated with
    6197              :  *  the event (even if they are disabled).  This function decides which
    6198              :  *  triggers actually need to be queued.  It is also called after each row,
    6199              :  *  even if there are no triggers for that event, if there are any AFTER
    6200              :  *  STATEMENT triggers for the statement which use transition tables, so that
    6201              :  *  the transition tuplestores can be built.  Furthermore, if the transition
    6202              :  *  capture is happening for UPDATEd rows being moved to another partition due
    6203              :  *  to the partition-key being changed, then this function is called once when
    6204              :  *  the row is deleted (to capture OLD row), and once when the row is inserted
    6205              :  *  into another partition (to capture NEW row).  This is done separately because
    6206              :  *  DELETE and INSERT happen on different tables.
    6207              :  *
    6208              :  *  Transition tuplestores are built now, rather than when events are pulled
    6209              :  *  off of the queue because AFTER ROW triggers are allowed to select from the
    6210              :  *  transition tables for the statement.
    6211              :  *
    6212              :  *  This contains special support to queue the update events for the case where
    6213              :  *  a partitioned table undergoing a cross-partition update may have foreign
    6214              :  *  keys pointing into it.  Normally, a partitioned table's row triggers are
    6215              :  *  not fired because the leaf partition(s) which are modified as a result of
    6216              :  *  the operation on the partitioned table contain the same triggers which are
    6217              :  *  fired instead. But that general scheme can cause problematic behavior with
    6218              :  *  foreign key triggers during cross-partition updates, which are implemented
    6219              :  *  as DELETE on the source partition followed by INSERT into the destination
    6220              :  *  partition.  Specifically, firing DELETE triggers would lead to the wrong
    6221              :  *  foreign key action to be enforced considering that the original command is
    6222              :  *  UPDATE; in this case, this function is called with relinfo as the
    6223              :  *  partitioned table, and src_partinfo and dst_partinfo referring to the
    6224              :  *  source and target leaf partitions, respectively.
    6225              :  *
    6226              :  *  is_crosspart_update is true either when a DELETE event is fired on the
    6227              :  *  source partition (which is to be ignored) or an UPDATE event is fired on
    6228              :  *  the root partitioned table.
    6229              :  * ----------
    6230              :  */
    6231              : static void
    6232       452938 : AfterTriggerSaveEvent(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    6233              :                       ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
    6234              :                       ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
    6235              :                       int event, bool row_trigger,
    6236              :                       TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    6237              :                       List *recheckIndexes, Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
    6238              :                       TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    6239              :                       bool is_crosspart_update)
    6240              : {
    6241       452938 :     Relation    rel = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    6242       452938 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    6243              :     AfterTriggerEventData new_event;
    6244              :     AfterTriggerSharedData new_shared;
    6245       452938 :     char        relkind = rel->rd_rel->relkind;
    6246              :     int         tgtype_event;
    6247              :     int         tgtype_level;
    6248              :     int         i;
    6249       452938 :     Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    6250              : 
    6251              :     /*
    6252              :      * Check state.  We use a normal test not Assert because it is possible to
    6253              :      * reach here in the wrong state given misconfigured RI triggers, in
    6254              :      * particular deferring a cascade action trigger.
    6255              :      */
    6256       452938 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    6257            0 :         elog(ERROR, "AfterTriggerSaveEvent() called outside of query");
    6258              : 
    6259              :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    6260       452938 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    6261         4166 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    6262              : 
    6263              :     /*
    6264              :      * If the directly named relation has any triggers with transition tables,
    6265              :      * then we need to capture transition tuples.
    6266              :      */
    6267       452938 :     if (row_trigger && transition_capture != NULL)
    6268              :     {
    6269        43911 :         TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple = transition_capture->tcs_original_insert_tuple;
    6270              : 
    6271              :         /*
    6272              :          * Capture the old tuple in the appropriate transition table based on
    6273              :          * the event.
    6274              :          */
    6275        43911 :         if (!TupIsNull(oldslot))
    6276              :         {
    6277              :             Tuplestorestate *old_tuplestore;
    6278              : 
    6279         3619 :             old_tuplestore = GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(event,
    6280              :                                                              oldslot,
    6281              :                                                              NULL,
    6282              :                                                              transition_capture);
    6283         3619 :             TransitionTableAddTuple(estate, event, transition_capture, relinfo,
    6284              :                                     oldslot, NULL, old_tuplestore);
    6285              :         }
    6286              : 
    6287              :         /*
    6288              :          * Capture the new tuple in the appropriate transition table based on
    6289              :          * the event.
    6290              :          */
    6291        43911 :         if (!TupIsNull(newslot))
    6292              :         {
    6293              :             Tuplestorestate *new_tuplestore;
    6294              : 
    6295        40507 :             new_tuplestore = GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(event,
    6296              :                                                              NULL,
    6297              :                                                              newslot,
    6298              :                                                              transition_capture);
    6299        40507 :             TransitionTableAddTuple(estate, event, transition_capture, relinfo,
    6300              :                                     newslot, original_insert_tuple, new_tuplestore);
    6301              :         }
    6302              : 
    6303              :         /*
    6304              :          * If transition tables are the only reason we're here, return. As
    6305              :          * mentioned above, we can also be here during update tuple routing in
    6306              :          * presence of transition tables, in which case this function is
    6307              :          * called separately for OLD and NEW, so we expect exactly one of them
    6308              :          * to be NULL.
    6309              :          */
    6310        43911 :         if (trigdesc == NULL ||
    6311        43751 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && !trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row) ||
    6312        40431 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && !trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row) ||
    6313          263 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && !trigdesc->trig_update_after_row) ||
    6314           32 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && (TupIsNull(oldslot) ^ TupIsNull(newslot))))
    6315        43807 :             return;
    6316              :     }
    6317              : 
    6318              :     /*
    6319              :      * We normally don't see partitioned tables here for row level triggers
    6320              :      * except in the special case of a cross-partition update.  In that case,
    6321              :      * nodeModifyTable.c:ExecCrossPartitionUpdateForeignKey() calls here to
    6322              :      * queue an update event on the root target partitioned table, also
    6323              :      * passing the source and destination partitions and their tuples.
    6324              :      */
    6325              :     Assert(!row_trigger ||
    6326              :            rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE ||
    6327              :            (is_crosspart_update &&
    6328              :             TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event) &&
    6329              :             src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL));
    6330              : 
    6331              :     /*
    6332              :      * Validate the event code and collect the associated tuple CTIDs.
    6333              :      *
    6334              :      * The event code will be used both as a bitmask and an array offset, so
    6335              :      * validation is important to make sure we don't walk off the edge of our
    6336              :      * arrays.
    6337              :      *
    6338              :      * Also, if we're considering statement-level triggers, check whether we
    6339              :      * already queued a set of them for this event, and cancel the prior set
    6340              :      * if so.  This preserves the behavior that statement-level triggers fire
    6341              :      * just once per statement and fire after row-level triggers.
    6342              :      */
    6343       409131 :     switch (event)
    6344              :     {
    6345       405677 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT:
    6346       405677 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT;
    6347       405677 :             if (row_trigger)
    6348              :             {
    6349              :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6350              :                 Assert(newslot != NULL);
    6351       405328 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(newslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6352       405328 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6353              :             }
    6354              :             else
    6355              :             {
    6356              :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6357              :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6358          349 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6359          349 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6360          349 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6361              :                                            CMD_INSERT, event);
    6362              :             }
    6363       405677 :             break;
    6364          975 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE:
    6365          975 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE;
    6366          975 :             if (row_trigger)
    6367              :             {
    6368              :                 Assert(oldslot != NULL);
    6369              :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6370          810 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(oldslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6371          810 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6372              :             }
    6373              :             else
    6374              :             {
    6375              :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6376              :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6377          165 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6378          165 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6379          165 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6380              :                                            CMD_DELETE, event);
    6381              :             }
    6382          975 :             break;
    6383         2474 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE:
    6384         2474 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE;
    6385         2474 :             if (row_trigger)
    6386              :             {
    6387              :                 Assert(oldslot != NULL);
    6388              :                 Assert(newslot != NULL);
    6389         2197 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(oldslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6390         2197 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(newslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6391              : 
    6392              :                 /*
    6393              :                  * Also remember the OIDs of partitions to fetch these tuples
    6394              :                  * out of later in AfterTriggerExecute().
    6395              :                  */
    6396         2197 :                 if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6397              :                 {
    6398              :                     Assert(src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL);
    6399          192 :                     new_event.ate_src_part =
    6400          192 :                         RelationGetRelid(src_partinfo->ri_RelationDesc);
    6401          192 :                     new_event.ate_dst_part =
    6402          192 :                         RelationGetRelid(dst_partinfo->ri_RelationDesc);
    6403              :                 }
    6404              :             }
    6405              :             else
    6406              :             {
    6407              :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6408              :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6409          277 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6410          277 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6411          277 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6412              :                                            CMD_UPDATE, event);
    6413              :             }
    6414         2474 :             break;
    6415            5 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE:
    6416            5 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE;
    6417              :             Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6418              :             Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6419            5 :             ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6420            5 :             ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6421            5 :             break;
    6422            0 :         default:
    6423            0 :             elog(ERROR, "invalid after-trigger event code: %d", event);
    6424              :             tgtype_event = 0;   /* keep compiler quiet */
    6425              :             break;
    6426              :     }
    6427              : 
    6428              :     /* Determine flags */
    6429       409131 :     if (!(relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE && row_trigger))
    6430              :     {
    6431       409103 :         if (row_trigger && event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE)
    6432              :         {
    6433         2187 :             if (relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6434          192 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE;
    6435              :             else
    6436         1995 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID;
    6437              :         }
    6438              :         else
    6439       406916 :             new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID;
    6440              :     }
    6441              : 
    6442              :     /* else, we'll initialize ate_flags for each trigger */
    6443              : 
    6444       409131 :     tgtype_level = (row_trigger ? TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW : TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT);
    6445              : 
    6446              :     /*
    6447              :      * Must convert/copy the source and destination partition tuples into the
    6448              :      * root partitioned table's format/slot, because the processing in the
    6449              :      * loop below expects both oldslot and newslot tuples to be in that form.
    6450              :      */
    6451       409131 :     if (row_trigger && rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6452              :     {
    6453              :         TupleTableSlot *rootslot;
    6454              :         TupleConversionMap *map;
    6455              : 
    6456          192 :         rootslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    6457          192 :         map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(src_partinfo);
    6458          192 :         if (map)
    6459           24 :             oldslot = execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    6460              :                                             oldslot,
    6461              :                                             rootslot);
    6462              :         else
    6463          168 :             oldslot = ExecCopySlot(rootslot, oldslot);
    6464              : 
    6465          192 :         rootslot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate, relinfo);
    6466          192 :         map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(dst_partinfo);
    6467          192 :         if (map)
    6468           28 :             newslot = execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    6469              :                                             newslot,
    6470              :                                             rootslot);
    6471              :         else
    6472          164 :             newslot = ExecCopySlot(rootslot, newslot);
    6473              :     }
    6474              : 
    6475      1639436 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    6476              :     {
    6477      1230305 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    6478              : 
    6479      1230305 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    6480              :                                   tgtype_level,
    6481              :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER,
    6482              :                                   tgtype_event))
    6483       619202 :             continue;
    6484       611103 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, event,
    6485              :                             modifiedCols, oldslot, newslot))
    6486          273 :             continue;
    6487              : 
    6488       610830 :         if (relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE && row_trigger)
    6489              :         {
    6490           29 :             if (fdw_tuplestore == NULL)
    6491              :             {
    6492           25 :                 fdw_tuplestore = GetCurrentFDWTuplestore();
    6493           25 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH;
    6494              :             }
    6495              :             else
    6496              :                 /* subsequent event for the same tuple */
    6497            4 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE;
    6498              :         }
    6499              : 
    6500              :         /*
    6501              :          * If the trigger is a foreign key enforcement trigger, there are
    6502              :          * certain cases where we can skip queueing the event because we can
    6503              :          * tell by inspection that the FK constraint will still pass. There
    6504              :          * are also some cases during cross-partition updates of a partitioned
    6505              :          * table where queuing the event can be skipped.
    6506              :          */
    6507       610830 :         if (TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event) || TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(event))
    6508              :         {
    6509         4353 :             switch (RI_FKey_trigger_type(trigger->tgfoid))
    6510              :             {
    6511         1700 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_PK:
    6512              : 
    6513              :                     /*
    6514              :                      * For cross-partitioned updates of partitioned PK table,
    6515              :                      * skip the event fired by the component delete on the
    6516              :                      * source leaf partition unless the constraint originates
    6517              :                      * in the partition itself (!tgisclone), because the
    6518              :                      * update event that will be fired on the root
    6519              :                      * (partitioned) target table will be used to perform the
    6520              :                      * necessary foreign key enforcement action.
    6521              :                      */
    6522         1700 :                     if (is_crosspart_update &&
    6523          338 :                         TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(event) &&
    6524          178 :                         trigger->tgisclone)
    6525          168 :                         continue;
    6526              : 
    6527              :                     /* Update or delete on trigger's PK table */
    6528         1532 :                     if (!RI_FKey_pk_upd_check_required(trigger, rel,
    6529              :                                                        oldslot, newslot))
    6530              :                     {
    6531              :                         /* skip queuing this event */
    6532          292 :                         continue;
    6533              :                     }
    6534         1240 :                     break;
    6535              : 
    6536          748 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_FK:
    6537              : 
    6538              :                     /*
    6539              :                      * Update on trigger's FK table.  We can skip the update
    6540              :                      * event fired on a partitioned table during a
    6541              :                      * cross-partition of that table, because the insert event
    6542              :                      * that is fired on the destination leaf partition would
    6543              :                      * suffice to perform the necessary foreign key check.
    6544              :                      * Moreover, RI_FKey_fk_upd_check_required() expects to be
    6545              :                      * passed a tuple that contains system attributes, most of
    6546              :                      * which are not present in the virtual slot belonging to
    6547              :                      * a partitioned table.
    6548              :                      */
    6549          748 :                     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE ||
    6550          668 :                         !RI_FKey_fk_upd_check_required(trigger, rel,
    6551              :                                                        oldslot, newslot))
    6552              :                     {
    6553              :                         /* skip queuing this event */
    6554          442 :                         continue;
    6555              :                     }
    6556          306 :                     break;
    6557              : 
    6558         1905 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_NONE:
    6559              : 
    6560              :                     /*
    6561              :                      * Not an FK trigger.  No need to queue the update event
    6562              :                      * fired during a cross-partitioned update of a
    6563              :                      * partitioned table, because the same row trigger must be
    6564              :                      * present in the leaf partition(s) that are affected as
    6565              :                      * part of this update and the events fired on them are
    6566              :                      * queued instead.
    6567              :                      */
    6568         1905 :                     if (row_trigger &&
    6569         1439 :                         rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6570           20 :                         continue;
    6571         1885 :                     break;
    6572              :             }
    6573              :         }
    6574              : 
    6575              :         /*
    6576              :          * If the trigger is a deferred unique constraint check trigger, only
    6577              :          * queue it if the unique constraint was potentially violated, which
    6578              :          * we know from index insertion time.
    6579              :          */
    6580       609908 :         if (trigger->tgfoid == F_UNIQUE_KEY_RECHECK)
    6581              :         {
    6582          139 :             if (!list_member_oid(recheckIndexes, trigger->tgconstrindid))
    6583           58 :                 continue;       /* Uniqueness definitely not violated */
    6584              :         }
    6585              : 
    6586              :         /*
    6587              :          * Fill in event structure and add it to the current query's queue.
    6588              :          * Note we set ats_table to NULL whenever this trigger doesn't use
    6589              :          * transition tables, to improve sharability of the shared event data.
    6590              :          */
    6591       609850 :         new_shared.ats_event =
    6592      1219700 :             (event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) |
    6593       609850 :             (row_trigger ? TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW : 0) |
    6594       609850 :             (trigger->tgdeferrable ? AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE : 0) |
    6595       609850 :             (trigger->tginitdeferred ? AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED : 0);
    6596       609850 :         new_shared.ats_tgoid = trigger->tgoid;
    6597       609850 :         new_shared.ats_relid = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    6598       609850 :         new_shared.ats_rolid = GetUserId();
    6599       609850 :         new_shared.ats_firing_id = 0;
    6600       609850 :         if ((trigger->tgoldtable || trigger->tgnewtable) &&
    6601              :             transition_capture != NULL)
    6602              :         {
    6603          487 :             switch (event)
    6604              :             {
    6605          192 :                 case TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT:
    6606          192 :                     new_shared.ats_table = transition_capture->tcs_insert_private;
    6607          192 :                     break;
    6608          155 :                 case TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE:
    6609          155 :                     new_shared.ats_table = transition_capture->tcs_update_private;
    6610          155 :                     break;
    6611          140 :                 case TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE:
    6612          140 :                     new_shared.ats_table = transition_capture->tcs_delete_private;
    6613          140 :                     break;
    6614            0 :                 default:
    6615              :                     /* Must be TRUNCATE, see switch above */
    6616            0 :                     new_shared.ats_table = NULL;
    6617            0 :                     break;
    6618              :             }
    6619              :         }
    6620              :         else
    6621       609363 :             new_shared.ats_table = NULL;
    6622       609850 :         new_shared.ats_modifiedcols = modifiedCols;
    6623              : 
    6624       609850 :         afterTriggerAddEvent(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].events,
    6625              :                              &new_event, &new_shared);
    6626              :     }
    6627              : 
    6628              :     /*
    6629              :      * Finally, spool any foreign tuple(s).  The tuplestore squashes them to
    6630              :      * minimal tuples, so this loses any system columns.  The executor lost
    6631              :      * those columns before us, for an unrelated reason, so this is fine.
    6632              :      */
    6633       409131 :     if (fdw_tuplestore)
    6634              :     {
    6635           25 :         if (oldslot != NULL)
    6636           16 :             tuplestore_puttupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, oldslot);
    6637           25 :         if (newslot != NULL)
    6638           18 :             tuplestore_puttupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, newslot);
    6639              :     }
    6640              : }
    6641              : 
    6642              : /*
    6643              :  * Detect whether we already queued BEFORE STATEMENT triggers for the given
    6644              :  * relation + operation, and set the flag so the next call will report "true".
    6645              :  */
    6646              : static bool
    6647          387 : before_stmt_triggers_fired(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    6648              : {
    6649              :     bool        result;
    6650              :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    6651              : 
    6652              :     /* Check state, like AfterTriggerSaveEvent. */
    6653          387 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    6654            0 :         elog(ERROR, "before_stmt_triggers_fired() called outside of query");
    6655              : 
    6656              :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    6657          387 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    6658          227 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    6659              : 
    6660              :     /*
    6661              :      * We keep this state in the AfterTriggersTableData that also holds
    6662              :      * transition tables for the relation + operation.  In this way, if we are
    6663              :      * forced to make a new set of transition tables because more tuples get
    6664              :      * entered after we've already fired triggers, we will allow a new set of
    6665              :      * statement triggers to get queued.
    6666              :      */
    6667          387 :     table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, cmdType);
    6668          387 :     result = table->before_trig_done;
    6669          387 :     table->before_trig_done = true;
    6670          387 :     return result;
    6671              : }
    6672              : 
    6673              : /*
    6674              :  * If we previously queued a set of AFTER STATEMENT triggers for the given
    6675              :  * relation + operation, and they've not been fired yet, cancel them.  The
    6676              :  * caller will queue a fresh set that's after any row-level triggers that may
    6677              :  * have been queued by the current sub-statement, preserving (as much as
    6678              :  * possible) the property that AFTER ROW triggers fire before AFTER STATEMENT
    6679              :  * triggers, and that the latter only fire once.  This deals with the
    6680              :  * situation where several FK enforcement triggers sequentially queue triggers
    6681              :  * for the same table into the same trigger query level.  We can't fully
    6682              :  * prevent odd behavior though: if there are AFTER ROW triggers taking
    6683              :  * transition tables, we don't want to change the transition tables once the
    6684              :  * first such trigger has seen them.  In such a case, any additional events
    6685              :  * will result in creating new transition tables and allowing new firings of
    6686              :  * statement triggers.
    6687              :  *
    6688              :  * This also saves the current event list location so that a later invocation
    6689              :  * of this function can cheaply find the triggers we're about to queue and
    6690              :  * cancel them.
    6691              :  */
    6692              : static void
    6693          791 : cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType, int tgevent)
    6694              : {
    6695              :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    6696          791 :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    6697              : 
    6698              :     /*
    6699              :      * We keep this state in the AfterTriggersTableData that also holds
    6700              :      * transition tables for the relation + operation.  In this way, if we are
    6701              :      * forced to make a new set of transition tables because more tuples get
    6702              :      * entered after we've already fired triggers, we will allow a new set of
    6703              :      * statement triggers to get queued without canceling the old ones.
    6704              :      */
    6705          791 :     table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, cmdType);
    6706              : 
    6707          791 :     if (table->after_trig_done)
    6708              :     {
    6709              :         /*
    6710              :          * We want to start scanning from the tail location that existed just
    6711              :          * before we inserted any statement triggers.  But the events list
    6712              :          * might've been entirely empty then, in which case scan from the
    6713              :          * current head.
    6714              :          */
    6715              :         AfterTriggerEvent event;
    6716              :         AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    6717              : 
    6718           48 :         if (table->after_trig_events.tail)
    6719              :         {
    6720           40 :             chunk = table->after_trig_events.tail;
    6721           40 :             event = (AfterTriggerEvent) table->after_trig_events.tailfree;
    6722              :         }
    6723              :         else
    6724              :         {
    6725            8 :             chunk = qs->events.head;
    6726            8 :             event = NULL;
    6727              :         }
    6728              : 
    6729           72 :         for_each_chunk_from(chunk)
    6730              :         {
    6731           48 :             if (event == NULL)
    6732            8 :                 event = (AfterTriggerEvent) CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    6733          100 :             for_each_event_from(event, chunk)
    6734              :             {
    6735           76 :                 AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    6736              : 
    6737              :                 /*
    6738              :                  * Exit loop when we reach events that aren't AS triggers for
    6739              :                  * the target relation.
    6740              :                  */
    6741           76 :                 if (evtshared->ats_relid != relid)
    6742            0 :                     goto done;
    6743           76 :                 if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) != tgevent)
    6744            0 :                     goto done;
    6745           76 :                 if (!TRIGGER_FIRED_FOR_STATEMENT(evtshared->ats_event))
    6746           24 :                     goto done;
    6747           52 :                 if (!TRIGGER_FIRED_AFTER(evtshared->ats_event))
    6748            0 :                     goto done;
    6749              :                 /* OK, mark it DONE */
    6750           52 :                 event->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    6751           52 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    6752              :             }
    6753              :             /* signal we must reinitialize event ptr for next chunk */
    6754           24 :             event = NULL;
    6755              :         }
    6756              :     }
    6757          767 : done:
    6758              : 
    6759              :     /* In any case, save current insertion point for next time */
    6760          791 :     table->after_trig_done = true;
    6761          791 :     table->after_trig_events = qs->events;
    6762          791 : }
    6763              : 
    6764              : /*
    6765              :  * GUC assign_hook for session_replication_role
    6766              :  */
    6767              : void
    6768         1927 : assign_session_replication_role(int newval, void *extra)
    6769              : {
    6770              :     /*
    6771              :      * Must flush the plan cache when changing replication role; but don't
    6772              :      * flush unnecessarily.
    6773              :      */
    6774         1927 :     if (SessionReplicationRole != newval)
    6775          648 :         ResetPlanCache();
    6776         1927 : }
    6777              : 
    6778              : /*
    6779              :  * SQL function pg_trigger_depth()
    6780              :  */
    6781              : Datum
    6782           84 : pg_trigger_depth(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
    6783              : {
    6784           84 :     PG_RETURN_INT32(MyTriggerDepth);
    6785              : }
    6786              : 
    6787              : /*
    6788              :  * Check whether a trigger modified a virtual generated column and replace the
    6789              :  * value with null if so.
    6790              :  *
    6791              :  * We need to check this so that we don't end up storing a non-null value in a
    6792              :  * virtual generated column.
    6793              :  *
    6794              :  * We don't need to check for stored generated columns, since those will be
    6795              :  * overwritten later anyway.
    6796              :  */
    6797              : static HeapTuple
    6798         1268 : check_modified_virtual_generated(TupleDesc tupdesc, HeapTuple tuple)
    6799              : {
    6800         1268 :     if (!(tupdesc->constr && tupdesc->constr->has_generated_virtual))
    6801         1257 :         return tuple;
    6802              : 
    6803           39 :     for (int i = 0; i < tupdesc->natts; i++)
    6804              :     {
    6805           28 :         if (TupleDescAttr(tupdesc, i)->attgenerated == ATTRIBUTE_GENERATED_VIRTUAL)
    6806              :         {
    6807           11 :             if (!heap_attisnull(tuple, i + 1, tupdesc))
    6808              :             {
    6809            8 :                 int         replCol = i + 1;
    6810            8 :                 Datum       replValue = 0;
    6811            8 :                 bool        replIsnull = true;
    6812              : 
    6813            8 :                 tuple = heap_modify_tuple_by_cols(tuple, tupdesc, 1, &replCol, &replValue, &replIsnull);
    6814              :             }
    6815              :         }
    6816              :     }
    6817              : 
    6818           11 :     return tuple;
    6819              : }
    6820              : 
    6821              : /*
    6822              :  * RegisterAfterTriggerBatchCallback
    6823              :  *      Register a function to be called when the current trigger-firing
    6824              :  *      batch completes.
    6825              :  *
    6826              :  * Must be called from within a trigger function's execution context
    6827              :  * (i.e., while afterTriggers state is active).
    6828              :  *
    6829              :  * The callback list is cleared after invocation, so the caller must
    6830              :  * re-register for each new batch if needed.
    6831              :  */
    6832              : void
    6833         1496 : RegisterAfterTriggerBatchCallback(AfterTriggerBatchCallback callback,
    6834              :                                   void *arg)
    6835              : {
    6836              :     AfterTriggerCallbackItem *item;
    6837              :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    6838              : 
    6839              :     /*
    6840              :      * Allocate in TopTransactionContext so the item survives for the duration
    6841              :      * of the batch, which may span multiple trigger invocations.
    6842              :      *
    6843              :      * Must be called while afterTriggers is active; callbacks registered
    6844              :      * outside a trigger-firing context would never fire.
    6845              :      */
    6846              :     Assert(afterTriggers.firing_depth > 0);
    6847              :     Assert(!afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks);
    6848         1496 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(TopTransactionContext);
    6849         1496 :     item = palloc(sizeof(AfterTriggerCallbackItem));
    6850         1496 :     item->callback = callback;
    6851         1496 :     item->arg = arg;
    6852         1496 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= 0)
    6853              :     {
    6854         1420 :         AfterTriggersQueryData *qs =
    6855         1420 :             &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    6856              : 
    6857         1420 :         qs->batch_callbacks = lappend(qs->batch_callbacks, item);
    6858              :     }
    6859              :     else
    6860           76 :         afterTriggers.batch_callbacks =
    6861           76 :             lappend(afterTriggers.batch_callbacks, item);
    6862         1496 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    6863         1496 : }
    6864              : 
    6865              : /*
    6866              :  * FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks
    6867              :  *      Invoke all callbacks in the given list.
    6868              :  *
    6869              :  * Memory cleanup of the list and its items is handled by the caller
    6870              :  * (AfterTriggerFreeQuery for query-level callbacks, AfterTriggerEndXact
    6871              :  * for top-level deferred callbacks).
    6872              :  */
    6873              : static void
    6874       598058 : FireAfterTriggerBatchCallbacks(List *callbacks)
    6875              : {
    6876              :     ListCell   *lc;
    6877              : 
    6878              :     Assert(afterTriggers.firing_depth > 0);
    6879       598058 :     afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks = true;
    6880       599262 :     foreach(lc, callbacks)
    6881              :     {
    6882         1496 :         AfterTriggerCallbackItem *item = lfirst(lc);
    6883              : 
    6884         1496 :         item->callback(item->arg);
    6885              :     }
    6886       597766 :     afterTriggers.firing_batch_callbacks = false;
    6887       597766 : }
    6888              : 
    6889              : /*
    6890              :  * AfterTriggerIsActive
    6891              :  *      Returns true if we're inside the after-trigger framework where
    6892              :  *      registered batch callbacks will actually be invoked.
    6893              :  *
    6894              :  * This is false during validateForeignKeyConstraint(), which calls
    6895              :  * RI trigger functions directly outside the after-trigger framework.
    6896              :  */
    6897              : bool
    6898       603694 : AfterTriggerIsActive(void)
    6899              : {
    6900       603694 :     return afterTriggers.firing_depth > 0;
    6901              : }
        

Generated by: LCOV version 2.0-1